blob: d4d0ee325c991df2482d400ee6a06ff554b923da [file] [log] [blame]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001==============================
2LLVM Language Reference Manual
3==============================
4
5.. contents::
6 :local:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00007 :depth: 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009Abstract
10========
11
12This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM
13is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides
14type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of
15representing 'all' high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code
16representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation
17strategy.
18
19Introduction
20============
21
22The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different
23forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation
24(suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human
25readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a
26powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler
27transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug
28and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are
29all equivalent. This document describes the human readable
30representation and notation.
31
32The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while
33being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be
34a "universal IR" of sorts, by being at a low enough level that
35high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how
36microprocessors are "universal IR's", allowing many source languages to
37be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as
38the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it
39can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of
40the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value
41instead of a memory location.
42
43.. _wellformed:
44
45Well-Formedness
46---------------
47
48It is important to note that this document describes 'well formed' LLVM
49assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts
50and what is considered 'well formed'. For example, the following
51instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
52
53.. code-block:: llvm
54
55 %x = add i32 1, %x
56
57because the definition of ``%x`` does not dominate all of its uses. The
58LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
59verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
60run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
61before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
62pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
63
64.. _identifiers:
65
66Identifiers
67===========
68
69LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
70identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the ``'@'``
71character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
72``'%'`` character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
73identifiers, for different purposes:
74
75#. Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
76 prefix. For example, ``%foo``, ``@DivisionByZero``,
77 ``%a.really.long.identifier``. The actual regular expression used is
Sean Silva9d01a5b2015-01-07 21:35:14 +000078 '``[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*``'. Identifiers that require other
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000079 characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special
80 characters may be escaped using ``"\xx"`` where ``xx`` is the ASCII
81 code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can
Hans Wennborg85e06532014-07-30 20:02:08 +000082 be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The ``"\01"`` prefix
83 can be used on global variables to suppress mangling.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000084#. Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
85 their prefix. For example, ``%12``, ``@2``, ``%44``.
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000086#. Constants, which are described in the section Constants_ below.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000087
88LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers
89don't need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set
90of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty.
91Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up
92with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table
93conflicts.
94
95Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
96languages. There are keywords for different opcodes ('``add``',
97'``bitcast``', '``ret``', etc...), for primitive type names ('``void``',
98'``i32``', etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
99with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
100(``'%'`` or ``'@'``).
101
102Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
103'``%X``' by 8:
104
105The easy way:
106
107.. code-block:: llvm
108
109 %result = mul i32 %X, 8
110
111After strength reduction:
112
113.. code-block:: llvm
114
Dmitri Gribenko675911d2013-01-26 13:30:13 +0000115 %result = shl i32 %X, 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000116
117And the hard way:
118
119.. code-block:: llvm
120
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +0000121 %0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
122 %1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000123 %result = add i32 %1, %1
124
125This last way of multiplying ``%X`` by 8 illustrates several important
126lexical features of LLVM:
127
128#. Comments are delimited with a '``;``' and go until the end of line.
129#. Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is
130 not assigned to a named value.
Sean Silva8ca11782013-05-20 23:31:12 +0000131#. Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000132 incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed
133 function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the
134 entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are
135 named, then it will get number 0.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000136
137It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When
138demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment
139that defines the type and name of value produced.
140
141High Level Structure
142====================
143
144Module Structure
145----------------
146
147LLVM programs are composed of ``Module``'s, each of which is a
148translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
149functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
150combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
151global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
152symbol table entries. Here is an example of the "hello world" module:
153
154.. code-block:: llvm
155
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000156 ; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
157 @.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000158
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000159 ; External declaration of the puts function
160 declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000161
162 ; Definition of main function
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000163 define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
164 ; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8 *...
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +0000165 %cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000166
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000167 ; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000168 call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +0000169 ret i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000170 }
171
172 ; Named metadata
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000173 !0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
Nick Lewyckya0de40a2014-08-13 04:54:05 +0000174 !foo = !{!0}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000175
176This example is made up of a :ref:`global variable <globalvars>` named
177"``.str``", an external declaration of the "``puts``" function, a
178:ref:`function definition <functionstructure>` for "``main``" and
179:ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` "``foo``".
180
181In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both
182functions and global variables are global values). Global values are
183represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer
184to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the
185following :ref:`linkage types <linkage>`.
186
187.. _linkage:
188
189Linkage Types
190-------------
191
192All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of
193linkage:
194
195``private``
196 Global values with "``private``" linkage are only directly
197 accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking
198 code into a module with an private global value may cause the
199 private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the
200 symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This
201 doesn't show up in any symbol table in the object file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000202``internal``
203 Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
204 (``STB_LOCAL`` in the case of ELF) in the object file. This
205 corresponds to the notion of the '``static``' keyword in C.
206``available_externally``
Peter Collingbourne45cd0c32015-12-14 19:22:37 +0000207 Globals with "``available_externally``" linkage are never emitted into
208 the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker's
209 perspective, an ``available_externally`` global is equivalent to
210 an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other
211 optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the
212 global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals
213 with ``available_externally`` linkage are allowed to be discarded at
214 will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is
215 only allowed on definitions, not declarations.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000216``linkonce``
217 Globals with "``linkonce``" linkage are merged with other globals of
218 the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement
219 some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must
220 be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the
221 body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later.
222 Unreferenced ``linkonce`` globals are allowed to be discarded. Note
223 that ``linkonce`` linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to
224 inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn't
225 know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition
226 within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger
227 definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use
228 "``linkonce_odr``" linkage.
229``weak``
230 "``weak``" linkage has the same merging semantics as ``linkonce``
231 linkage, except that unreferenced globals with ``weak`` linkage may
232 not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared "weak"
233 in C source code.
234``common``
235 "``common``" linkage is most similar to "``weak``" linkage, but they
236 are used for tentative definitions in C, such as "``int X;``" at
237 global scope. Symbols with "``common``" linkage are merged in the
238 same way as ``weak symbols``, and they may not be deleted if
239 unreferenced. ``common`` symbols may not have an explicit section,
240 must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked
241 ':ref:`constant <globalvars>`'. Functions and aliases may not have
242 common linkage.
243
244.. _linkage_appending:
245
246``appending``
247 "``appending``" linkage may only be applied to global variables of
248 pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending
249 linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended
250 together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the
251 system linker append together "sections" with identical names when
252 .o files are linked.
Rafael Espindolae64619c2016-05-16 21:14:24 +0000253
254 Unfortunately this doesn't correspond to any feature in .o files, so it
255 can only be used for variables like ``llvm.global_ctors`` which llvm
256 interprets specially.
257
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000258``extern_weak``
259 The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the
260 symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null
261 instead of being an undefined reference.
262``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``
263 Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
264 functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
265 ``C++``, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000266 "one definition rule" --- "ODR"). Such languages can use the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000267 ``linkonce_odr`` and ``weak_odr`` linkage types to indicate that the
268 global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage
269 types are otherwise the same as their non-``odr`` versions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000270``external``
271 If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally
272 visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to
273 resolve external symbol references.
274
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000275It is illegal for a function *declaration* to have any linkage type
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000276other than ``external`` or ``extern_weak``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000277
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000278.. _callingconv:
279
280Calling Conventions
281-------------------
282
283LLVM :ref:`functions <functionstructure>`, :ref:`calls <i_call>` and
284:ref:`invokes <i_invoke>` can all have an optional calling convention
285specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic
286caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined.
287The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be
288added in the future:
289
290"``ccc``" - The C calling convention
291 This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention
292 is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling
293 convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some
294 mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of
295 the function (as does normal C).
296"``fastcc``" - The fast calling convention
297 This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible
298 (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention
299 allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast
300 code for the target, without having to conform to an externally
301 specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). `Tail calls can only
302 be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is
303 used. <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ This calling convention does not
304 support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly
305 match the prototype of the function definition.
306"``coldcc``" - The cold calling convention
307 This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as
308 efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not
309 commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers
310 so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side.
311 This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the
312 prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000313 function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn't consider such function
314 calls for inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000315"``cc 10``" - GHC convention
316 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
317 the `Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC) <http://www.haskell.org/ghc>`_.
318 It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this
319 by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should
320 not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an
321 alternative to the *register pinning* performance technique often
322 used when implementing functional programming languages. At the
323 moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following
324 limitations:
325
326 - On *X86-32* only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No
327 floating point types are supported.
328 - On *X86-64* only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6
329 floating point parameters.
330
331 This calling convention supports `tail call
332 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires both the
333 caller and callee are using it.
334"``cc 11``" - The HiPE calling convention
335 This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by
336 the `High-Performance Erlang
337 (HiPE) <http://www.it.uu.se/research/group/hipe/>`_ compiler, *the*
338 native code compiler of the `Ericsson's Open Source Erlang/OTP
339 system <http://www.erlang.org/download.shtml>`_. It uses more
340 registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling
341 convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling
342 convention properly supports `tail call
343 optimization <CodeGenerator.html#id80>`_ but requires that both the
344 caller and the callee use it. It uses a *register pinning*
345 mechanism, similar to GHC's convention, for keeping frequently
346 accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers.
347 At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64
348 bit).
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000349"``webkit_jscc``" - WebKit's JavaScript calling convention
350 This calling convention has been implemented for `WebKit FTL JIT
351 <https://trac.webkit.org/wiki/FTLJIT>`_. It passes arguments on the
352 stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the
353 platform's customary return register.
354"``anyregcc``" - Dynamic calling convention for code patching
355 This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code
356 sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000357 arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +0000358 allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to
359 llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records
360 the location of its arguments in a side table. See :doc:`StackMaps`.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000361"``preserve_mostcc``" - The `PreserveMost` calling convention
Eli Bendersky45324ce2015-04-02 15:20:04 +0000362 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as
363 unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the `C`
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000364 calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it
365 uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the
366 burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000367 call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers,
368 then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't
369 apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000370
371 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
372 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers
373 (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
374
375 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
376 that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000377 of code that doesn't use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000378 another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved
Juergen Ributzka5d05ed12014-01-17 22:24:35 +0000379 registers, which haven't already been saved by the caller. The
380 `PreserveMost` calling convention is very similar to the `cold` calling
381 convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for
382 different types of function calls. `coldcc` is for function calls that are
383 rarely executed, whereas `preserve_mostcc` function calls are intended to be
384 on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore `preserve_mostcc`
385 doesn't prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000386
387 This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC
388 runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time.
389 Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to
390 the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used
391 by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only
392 supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the
393 future.
394"``preserve_allcc``" - The `PreserveAll` calling convention
395 This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less
396 intrusive than the `PreserveMost` calling convention. This calling
397 convention also behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on how
398 arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
399 caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and
Juergen Ributzka980f2dc2014-01-30 02:39:00 +0000400 recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If
401 the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be
402 preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn't apply for values
403 returned in callee-saved registers.
Juergen Ributzkae6250132014-01-17 19:47:03 +0000404
405 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
406 R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves
407 all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
408
409 The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions
410 that don't need to call out to any other functions.
411
412 This calling convention, like the `PreserveMost` calling convention, will be
413 used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered
414 experimental at this time.
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000415"``cxx_fast_tlscc``" - The `CXX_FAST_TLS` calling convention for access functions
Manman Ren17567d22015-12-07 21:40:09 +0000416 Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access
417 function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization
418 block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access
419 a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific
420 sequence.
421
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000422 This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by
Manman Ren17567d22015-12-07 21:40:09 +0000423 preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are
424 perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
425
426 This calling convention behaves identical to the `C` calling convention on
427 how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of
428 caller/callee-saved registers.
429
430 Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set
431 of preserved registers, we can't use the existing `PreserveMost`.
Manman Ren19c7bbe2015-12-04 17:40:13 +0000432
433 - On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for
434 RDI and RAX.
Manman Renf8bdd882016-04-05 22:41:47 +0000435"``swiftcc``" - This calling convention is used for Swift language.
436 - On X86-64 RCX and R8 are available for additional integer returns, and
437 XMM2 and XMM3 are available for additional FP/vector returns.
Manman Ren802cd6f2016-04-05 22:44:44 +0000438 - On iOS platforms, we use AAPCS-VFP calling convention.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000439"``cc <n>``" - Numbered convention
440 Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing
441 target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific
442 calling conventions start at 64.
443
444More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to
445support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent
446convention.
447
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000448.. _visibilitystyles:
449
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000450Visibility Styles
451-----------------
452
453All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility
454styles:
455
456"``default``" - Default style
457 On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility
458 means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in
459 shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden.
460 On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible
461 to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to "external
462 linkage" in the language.
463"``hidden``" - Hidden style
464 Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the
465 same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden
466 visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the
467 dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared
468 library) can reference it directly.
469"``protected``" - Protected style
470 On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be
471 placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the
472 defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol
473 cannot be overridden by another module.
474
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithb80de102014-05-07 22:57:20 +0000475A symbol with ``internal`` or ``private`` linkage must have ``default``
476visibility.
477
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000478.. _dllstorageclass:
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000479
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000480DLL Storage Classes
481-------------------
482
483All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following
484DLL storage class:
485
486``dllimport``
487 "``dllimport``" causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via
488 a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the
489 symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by
490 combining ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name.
491``dllexport``
492 "``dllexport``" causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer
493 in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with the ``dllimport`` attribute. On
494 Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining
495 ``__imp_`` and the function or variable name. Since this storage class
496 exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know
497 it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
498
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000499.. _tls_model:
500
501Thread Local Storage Models
502---------------------------
503
504A variable may be defined as ``thread_local``, which means that it will
505not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
506variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
507TLS model may be specified:
508
509``localdynamic``
510 For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
511``initialexec``
512 For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
513``localexec``
514 For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
515
516If no explicit model is given, the "general dynamic" model is used.
517
518The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see `ELF Handling For
519Thread-Local Storage <http://people.redhat.com/drepper/tls.pdf>`_ for
520more information on under which circumstances the different models may
521be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified
522model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
523
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000524A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000525the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
526
Chih-Hung Hsieh1e859582015-07-28 16:24:05 +0000527For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls
528flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
529
Rafael Espindola3bc64d52014-05-26 21:30:40 +0000530.. _namedtypes:
531
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000532Structure Types
533---------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000534
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000535LLVM IR allows you to specify both "identified" and "literal" :ref:`structure
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000536types <t_struct>`. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types
537are never uniqued. An :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>` can also be used
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +0000538to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000539
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000540An example of an identified structure specification is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000541
542.. code-block:: llvm
543
544 %mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
545
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000546Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only
Reid Kleckner7c84d1d2014-03-05 02:21:50 +0000547literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000548
549.. _globalvars:
550
551Global Variables
552----------------
553
554Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000555instead of run-time.
556
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000557Global variable definitions must be initialized.
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000558
559Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which
560case they don't have an initializer.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000561
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000562Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section
563to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified.
564
Michael Gottesman006039c2013-01-31 05:48:48 +0000565A variable may be defined as a global ``constant``, which indicates that
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000566the contents of the variable will **never** be modified (enabling better
567optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
568section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
Michael Gottesman1cffcf742013-01-31 05:44:04 +0000569initialization cannot be marked ``constant`` as there is a store to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000570variable.
571
572LLVM explicitly allows *declarations* of global variables to be marked
573constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This
574capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the
575program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that
576optimizations based on the 'constantness' are valid for the translation
577units that do not include the definition.
578
579As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope
580(i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables
581always define a pointer to their "content" type because they describe a
582region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through
583pointers.
584
585Global variables can be marked with ``unnamed_addr`` which indicates
586that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
587like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
588initializer. Note that a constant with significant address *can* be
589merged with a ``unnamed_addr`` constant, the result being a constant
590whose address is significant.
591
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000592If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
593not be significant within the module.
594
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000595A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific
596numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces
597may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target
598instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space
599is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
600
601LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the
602target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000603Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary
604support.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000605
Michael Gottesmane743a302013-02-04 03:22:00 +0000606By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000607variables defined within the module are not modified from their
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000608initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000609true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
610module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
Yunzhong Gaof5b769e2013-12-05 18:37:54 +0000611``@llvm.used`` or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
612by marking the variable with ``externally_initialized``.
Michael Gottesmanef2bc772013-02-03 09:57:15 +0000613
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000614An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
615power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
616alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
617convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
618to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
619to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
620case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
621assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
622iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +0000623iteration. The maximum alignment is ``1 << 29``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000624
Peter Collingbournecceae7f2016-05-31 23:01:54 +0000625Globals can also have a :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>` and
626an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000627
Peter Collingbourne69ba0162015-02-04 00:42:45 +0000628Variables and aliases can have a
Rafael Espindola59f7eba2014-05-28 18:15:43 +0000629:ref:`Thread Local Storage Model <tls_model>`.
630
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000631Syntax::
632
Rafael Espindola32483a72016-05-10 18:22:45 +0000633 @<GlobalVarName> = [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000634 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [AddrSpace]
635 [ExternallyInitialized]
Bob Wilson85b24f22014-06-12 20:40:33 +0000636 <global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000637 [, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
Peter Collingbournecceae7f2016-05-31 23:01:54 +0000638 [, align <Alignment>] (, !name !N)*
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000639
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000640For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space
641with an initializer, section, and alignment:
642
643.. code-block:: llvm
644
645 @G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
646
Rafael Espindola5d1b7452013-10-29 13:44:11 +0000647The following example just declares a global variable
648
649.. code-block:: llvm
650
651 @G = external global i32
652
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000653The following example defines a thread-local global with the
654``initialexec`` TLS model:
655
656.. code-block:: llvm
657
658 @G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
659
660.. _functionstructure:
661
662Functions
663---------
664
665LLVM function definitions consist of the "``define``" keyword, an
666optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000667style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`,
668an optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000669an optional ``unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional
670:ref:`parameter attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function
671name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional :ref:`parameter
672attributes <paramattrs>`), optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>`,
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000673an optional section, an optional alignment,
674an optional :ref:`comdat <langref_comdats>`,
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +0000675an optional :ref:`garbage collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`,
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000676an optional :ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`,
677an optional :ref:`personality <personalityfn>`,
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +0000678an optional list of attached :ref:`metadata <metadata>`,
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +0000679an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000680
681LLVM function declarations consist of the "``declare``" keyword, an
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000682optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional :ref:`visibility style
683<visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class <dllstorageclass>`, an
684optional :ref:`calling convention <callingconv>`, an optional ``unnamed_addr``
685or ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute, a return type, an optional :ref:`parameter
686attribute <paramattrs>` for the return type, a function name, a possibly
687empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional :ref:`garbage
688collector name <gc>`, an optional :ref:`prefix <prefixdata>`, and an optional
689:ref:`prologue <prologuedata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000690
Bill Wendling6822ecb2013-10-27 05:09:12 +0000691A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control
692Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label
693(giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions,
694and ends with a :ref:`terminator <terminators>` instruction (such as a branch or
695function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an
696implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for
697unnamed temporaries (:ref:`see above<identifiers>`). For example, if a function
698entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label "%0",
699then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be "%1", etc.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000700
701The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is
702immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed
703to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to
704the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no
705predecessors, it also cannot have any :ref:`PHI nodes <i_phi>`.
706
707LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the
708target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified.
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000709Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000710
711An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present,
712or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set
713by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment
714is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much
715alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
716
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000717If the ``unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to not
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000718be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
719
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000720If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
721not be significant within the module.
722
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000723Syntax::
724
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000725 define [linkage] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000726 [cconv] [ret attrs]
727 <ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000728 [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] [fn Attrs] [section "name"]
729 [comdat [($name)]] [align N] [gc] [prefix Constant]
730 [prologue Constant] [personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000731
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000732The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each
733argument is of the following form:
Dan Liew2661dfc2014-08-20 15:06:30 +0000734
735Syntax::
736
737 <type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
738
739
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +0000740.. _langref_aliases:
741
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000742Aliases
743-------
744
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000745Aliases, unlike function or variables, don't create any new data. They
746are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
747
748Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a
749constant expression.
750
Nico Rieck7157bb72014-01-14 15:22:47 +0000751Aliases may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>`, an optional
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000752:ref:`visibility style <visibility>`, an optional :ref:`DLL storage class
753<dllstorageclass>` and an optional :ref:`tls model <tls_model>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000754
755Syntax::
756
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000757 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [(unnamed_addr|local_unnamed_addr)] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000758
Rafael Espindola2fb5bc32014-03-13 23:18:37 +0000759The linkage must be one of ``private``, ``internal``, ``linkonce``, ``weak``,
Rafael Espindola716e7402013-11-01 17:09:14 +0000760``linkonce_odr``, ``weak_odr``, ``external``. Note that some system linkers
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000761might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
Rafael Espindola78527052013-10-06 15:10:43 +0000762
Eric Christopher1e61ffd2015-02-19 18:46:25 +0000763Aliases that are not ``unnamed_addr`` are guaranteed to have the same address as
Rafael Espindola42a4c9f2014-06-06 01:20:28 +0000764the aliasee expression. ``unnamed_addr`` ones are only guaranteed to point
765to the same content.
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000766
Peter Collingbourne96efdd62016-06-14 21:01:22 +0000767If the ``local_unnamed_addr`` attribute is given, the address is known to
768not be significant within the module.
769
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000770Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which
771some can only be checked when producing an object file:
Rafael Espindolaf3336bc2014-03-12 20:15:49 +0000772
Rafael Espindola64c1e182014-06-03 02:41:57 +0000773* The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly
774 time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
775
776* No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the
777 intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an
778 object file.
779
780* No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that
781 would require a relocation, which is not possible.
Rafael Espindola24a669d2014-03-27 15:26:56 +0000782
Dmitry Polukhina1feff72016-04-07 12:32:19 +0000783.. _langref_ifunc:
784
785IFuncs
786-------
787
788IFuncs, like as aliases, don't create any new data or func. They are just a new
789symbol that dynamic linker resolves at runtime by calling a resolver function.
790
791IFuncs have a name and a resolver that is a function called by dynamic linker
792that returns address of another function associated with the name.
793
794IFunc may have an optional :ref:`linkage type <linkage>` and an optional
795:ref:`visibility style <visibility>`.
796
797Syntax::
798
799 @<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] ifunc <IFuncTy>, <ResolverTy>* @<Resolver>
800
801
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000802.. _langref_comdats:
803
804Comdats
805-------
806
807Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
808
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000809Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000810specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000811that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000812aliasee computes to, if any.
813
814Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should
815choose between keys in two different object files.
816
817Syntax::
818
819 $<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
820
821The selection kind must be one of the following:
822
823``any``
824 The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
825``exactmatch``
826 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
827 same data.
828``largest``
829 The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
830``noduplicates``
831 The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
832``samesize``
833 The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the
834 same amount of data.
835
836Note that the Mach-O platform doesn't support COMDATs and ELF only supports
837``any`` as a selection kind.
838
839Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if
840the COMDAT key's section is the largest:
841
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +0000842.. code-block:: text
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000843
844 $foo = comdat largest
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000845 @foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000846
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000847 define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000848 ret void
849 }
850
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000851As a syntactic sugar the ``$name`` can be omitted if the name is the same as
852the global name:
853
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +0000854.. code-block:: text
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000855
856 $foo = comdat any
857 @foo = global i32 2, comdat
858
859
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000860In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
861``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST`` containing the contents of the ``@foo`` symbol
862and another COMDAT section with selection kind
863``IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE`` which is associated with the first COMDAT
Hans Wennborg0def0662014-09-10 17:05:08 +0000864section and contains the contents of the ``@bar`` symbol.
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000865
866There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object.
867It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when
868targeting COFF.
869The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine
870which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind.
871Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the
872linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed
873if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
874
875The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results.
876For example:
877
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +0000878.. code-block:: text
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000879
880 $foo = comdat any
881 $bar = comdat any
Rafael Espindola83a362c2015-01-06 22:55:16 +0000882 @g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
883 @g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000884
885From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000886with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000887COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by
888sections.
889
Peter Collingbourne1feef2e2015-06-30 19:10:31 +0000890Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may
891create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000892COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals
Peter Collingbourne1feef2e2015-06-30 19:10:31 +0000893in individual sections (e.g. when `-data-sections` or `-function-sections`
894is supplied to `llc`).
David Majnemerdad0a642014-06-27 18:19:56 +0000895
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000896.. _namedmetadatastructure:
897
898Named Metadata
899--------------
900
901Named metadata is a collection of metadata. :ref:`Metadata
902nodes <metadata>` (but not metadata strings) are the only valid
903operands for a named metadata.
904
Filipe Cabecinhas62431b12015-06-02 21:25:08 +0000905#. Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
906 metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
907 identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed. ``"\xx"`` type escapes
908 are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
909
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000910Syntax::
911
912 ; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +0000913 !0 = !{!"zero"}
914 !1 = !{!"one"}
915 !2 = !{!"two"}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000916 ; A named metadata.
917 !name = !{!0, !1, !2}
918
919.. _paramattrs:
920
921Parameter Attributes
922--------------------
923
924The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of
925*parameter attributes* associated with them. Parameter attributes are
926used to communicate additional information about the result or
927parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part
928of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different
929parameter attributes can have the same function type.
930
931Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
932If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated.
933For example:
934
935.. code-block:: llvm
936
937 declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
938 declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
939 declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
940
941Note that any attributes for the function result (``nounwind``,
942``readonly``) come immediately after the argument list.
943
944Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
945
946``zeroext``
947 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
948 value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target's
Hans Wennborg850ec6c2016-02-08 19:34:30 +0000949 ABI by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000950``signext``
951 This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return
952 value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target's
953 ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or
954 the callee (for a return value).
955``inreg``
956 This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +0000957 in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +0000958 a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as
959 opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between
960 two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is
961 target-specific.
962``byval``
963 This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by
964 value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of
965 the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee
966 is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only
967 valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass
968 structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to
969 scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the
970 callee (for example, ``readonly`` functions should not write to
971 ``byval`` parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return
972 values.
973
974 The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the
975 align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to
976 form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call
977 site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator
978 makes a target-specific assumption.
979
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000980.. _attr_inalloca:
981
982``inalloca``
983
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +0000984 The ``inalloca`` argument attribute allows the caller to take the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000985 address of outgoing stack arguments. An ``inalloca`` argument must
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000986 be a pointer to stack memory produced by an ``alloca`` instruction.
987 The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000988 inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have the ``inalloca``
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000989 attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000990
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000991 An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000992 the call may deallocate it. The ``inalloca`` attribute cannot be
Reid Kleckner436c42e2014-01-17 23:58:17 +0000993 used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +0000994 storage, like ``inreg``, ``nest``, ``sret``, or ``byval``. The
Reid Klecknerf5b76512014-01-31 23:50:57 +0000995 ``inalloca`` attribute also disables LLVM's implicit lowering of
996 large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors
997 must lower them with ``sret`` pointers.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +0000998
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +0000999 When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have
1000 been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001001 results are undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack
Reid Kleckner60d3a832014-01-16 22:59:24 +00001002 space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it
1003 must be cleared off with :ref:`llvm.stackrestore
1004 <int_stackrestore>`.
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +00001005
1006 See :doc:`InAlloca` for more information on how to use this
1007 attribute.
1008
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001009``sret``
1010 This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a
1011 structure that is the return value of the function in the source
1012 program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid:
Eli Bendersky4f2162f2013-01-23 22:05:19 +00001013 loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001014 not to trap and to be properly aligned. This may only be applied to
1015 the first parameter. This is not a valid attribute for return
1016 values.
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00001017
Hal Finkelccc70902014-07-22 16:58:55 +00001018``align <n>``
1019 This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to
1020 have the specified alignment.
1021
1022 Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
1023 ``byval`` attribute.
1024
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00001025.. _noalias:
1026
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001027``noalias``
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +00001028 This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values
1029 :ref:`based <pointeraliasing>` on the argument or return value are not also
1030 accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not
1031 *based* on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value
1032 also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the
1033 responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met.
1034 For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in
1035 :ref:`alias analysis <Must, May, or No>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001036
1037 Note that this definition of ``noalias`` is intentionally similar
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +00001038 to the definition of ``restrict`` in C99 for function arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001039
1040 For function return values, C99's ``restrict`` is not meaningful,
Hal Finkel12d36302014-11-21 02:22:46 +00001041 while LLVM's ``noalias`` is. Furthermore, the semantics of the ``noalias``
1042 attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute
1043 when used on function arguments. On function return values, the ``noalias``
1044 attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation
1045 function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the
1046 storage for any other object accessible to the caller.
1047
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001048``nocapture``
1049 This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the
1050 pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid
David Majnemer7f324202016-05-26 17:36:22 +00001051 attribute for return values. Addresses used in volatile operations
1052 are considered to be captured.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001053
1054.. _nest:
1055
1056``nest``
1057 This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the
1058 :ref:`trampoline intrinsics <int_trampoline>`. This is not a valid
Stephen Linb8bd2322013-04-20 05:14:40 +00001059 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1060
1061``returned``
Stephen Linfec5b0b2013-06-20 21:55:10 +00001062 This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return
Hal Finkel3b66caa2016-07-10 21:52:39 +00001063 value. This is a hint to the optimizer and code generator used when
1064 generating the caller, allowing value propagation, tail call optimization,
1065 and omission of register saves and restores in some cases; it is not
1066 checked or enforced when generating the callee. The parameter and the
1067 function return type must be valid operands for the
1068 :ref:`bitcast instruction <i_bitcast>`. This is not a valid attribute for
1069 return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001070
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001071``nonnull``
1072 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This
1073 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not
1074 checked or enforced by LLVM, the caller must ensure that the pointer
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001075 passed in is non-null, or the callee must ensure that the returned pointer
Nick Lewyckyd52b1522014-05-20 01:23:40 +00001076 is non-null.
1077
Hal Finkelb0407ba2014-07-18 15:51:28 +00001078``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1079 This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
1080 attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
1081 is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
1082 trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
1083 in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
1084 size of the pointee type. The ``nonnull`` attribute does not imply
1085 dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an
1086 array), however ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` does imply ``nonnull`` in
1087 ``addrspace(0)`` (which is the default address space).
1088
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001089``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1090 This indicates that the parameter or return value isn't both
1091 non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to ``<n>`` bytes) at the same
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001092 time. All non-null pointers tagged with
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001093 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` are ``dereferenceable(<n>)``.
1094 For address space 0 ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)`` implies that
1095 a pointer is exactly one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)`` or ``null``,
1096 and in other address spaces ``dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)``
1097 implies that a pointer is at least one of ``dereferenceable(<n>)``
1098 or ``null`` (i.e. it may be both ``null`` and
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001099 ``dereferenceable(<n>)``). This attribute may only be applied to
Sanjoy Das31ea6d12015-04-16 20:29:50 +00001100 pointer typed parameters.
1101
Manman Renf46262e2016-03-29 17:37:21 +00001102``swiftself``
1103 This indicates that the parameter is the self/context parameter. This is not
1104 a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one
1105 parameter.
1106
Manman Ren9bfd0d02016-04-01 21:41:15 +00001107``swifterror``
1108 This attribute is motivated to model and optimize Swift error handling. It
1109 can be applied to a parameter with pointer to pointer type or a
1110 pointer-sized alloca. At the call site, the actual argument that corresponds
1111 to a ``swifterror`` parameter has to come from a ``swifterror`` alloca. A
1112 ``swifterror`` value (either the parameter or the alloca) can only be loaded
1113 and stored from, or used as a ``swifterror`` argument. This is not a valid
1114 attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
1115
1116 These constraints allow the calling convention to optimize access to
1117 ``swifterror`` variables by associating them with a specific register at
1118 call boundaries rather than placing them in memory. Since this does change
1119 the calling convention, a function which uses the ``swifterror`` attribute
1120 on a parameter is not ABI-compatible with one which does not.
1121
1122 These constraints also allow LLVM to assume that a ``swifterror`` argument
1123 does not alias any other memory visible within a function and that a
1124 ``swifterror`` alloca passed as an argument does not escape.
1125
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001126.. _gc:
1127
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001128Garbage Collector Strategy Names
1129--------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001130
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001131Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001132string:
1133
1134.. code-block:: llvm
1135
1136 define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
1137
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001138The supported values of *name* includes those :ref:`built in to LLVM
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001139<builtin-gc-strategies>` and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001140strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001141named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00001142garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001143which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001144
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001145.. _prefixdata:
1146
1147Prefix Data
1148-----------
1149
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001150Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code
1151generator will emit immediately before the function's entrypoint.
1152The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate
1153language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it
1154available through the function pointer while still allowing the
1155function pointer to be called.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001156
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001157To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
1158function pointer to a pointer to the constant's type and dereference
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001159index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001160the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
1161with a single ``i32``,
1162
1163.. code-block:: llvm
1164
1165 define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
1166
1167The prefix data can be referenced as,
1168
1169.. code-block:: llvm
1170
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00001171 %0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
1172 %a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00001173 %b = load i32, i32* %a
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001174
1175Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001176of the prefix data's type. The function will be placed such that the
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001177beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size
1178of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the
1179function's entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the
1180function's entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix
1181data.
1182
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001183A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001184to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1185optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1186
1187.. _prologuedata:
1188
1189Prologue Data
1190-------------
1191
1192The ``prologue`` attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
1193be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
1194function hot-patching and instrumentation.
1195
1196To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001197have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001198bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the
1199module's target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001200the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001201the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001202definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001203makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001204
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001205A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is ``i8 144``,
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001206which encodes the ``nop`` instruction:
1207
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00001208.. code-block:: text
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001209
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001210 define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001211
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001212Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
1213which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001214x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode ``jmp .+10``:
1215
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00001216.. code-block:: text
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001217
1218 %0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
1219
Peter Collingbourne51d2de72014-12-03 02:08:38 +00001220 define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001221
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001222A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
Peter Collingbourne3fa50f92013-09-16 01:08:15 +00001223to the ``available_externally`` linkage in that the data may be used by the
1224optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
1225
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001226.. _personalityfn:
1227
1228Personality Function
David Majnemerc5ad8a92015-06-17 21:21:16 +00001229--------------------
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00001230
1231The ``personality`` attribute permits functions to specify what function
1232to use for exception handling.
1233
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001234.. _attrgrp:
1235
1236Attribute Groups
1237----------------
1238
1239Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
1240the IR. They are important for keeping ``.ll`` files readable, because a lot of
1241functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
1242``.ll`` file that corresponds to a single ``.c`` file, the single attribute
1243group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
1244
1245An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
1246object references the attribute group's ID (e.g. ``#37``). An object may refer
1247to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
1248different groups are merged.
1249
1250Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be
1251inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn't use SSE instructions:
1252
1253.. code-block:: llvm
1254
1255 ; Target-independent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001256 attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001257
1258 ; Target-dependent attributes:
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001259 attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
Bill Wendling63b88192013-02-06 06:52:58 +00001260
1261 ; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
1262 define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
1263
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001264.. _fnattrs:
1265
1266Function Attributes
1267-------------------
1268
1269Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about
1270a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the
1271function, not of the function type, so functions with different function
1272attributes can have the same function type.
1273
1274Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified.
1275If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For
1276example:
1277
1278.. code-block:: llvm
1279
1280 define void @f() noinline { ... }
1281 define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
1282 define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
1283 define void @f() optsize { ... }
1284
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001285``alignstack(<n>)``
1286 This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and
1287 epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer.
1288 Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in
1289 parentheses.
George Burgess IV278199f2016-04-12 01:05:35 +00001290``allocsize(<EltSizeParam>[, <NumEltsParam>])``
1291 This attribute indicates that the annotated function will always return at
1292 least a given number of bytes (or null). Its arguments are zero-indexed
1293 parameter numbers; if one argument is provided, then it's assumed that at
1294 least ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam]`` bytes will be available at the
1295 returned pointer. If two are provided, then it's assumed that
1296 ``CallSite.Args[EltSizeParam] * CallSite.Args[NumEltsParam]`` bytes are
1297 available. The referenced parameters must be integer types. No assumptions
1298 are made about the contents of the returned block of memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001299``alwaysinline``
1300 This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline
1301 this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active
1302 inlining size threshold for this caller.
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001303``builtin``
1304 This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
1305 recognized as a built-in function, even though the function's declaration
Michael Gottesman3a6a9672013-07-02 21:32:56 +00001306 uses the ``nobuiltin`` attribute. This is only valid at call sites for
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00001307 direct calls to functions that are declared with the ``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001308 attribute.
Michael Gottesman296adb82013-06-27 22:48:08 +00001309``cold``
1310 This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When
1311 computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold
1312 function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low
1313 weight.
Owen Anderson85fa7d52015-05-26 23:48:40 +00001314``convergent``
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001315 In some parallel execution models, there exist operations that cannot be
1316 made control-dependent on any additional values. We call such operations
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001317 ``convergent``, and mark them with this attribute.
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001318
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001319 The ``convergent`` attribute may appear on functions or call/invoke
1320 instructions. When it appears on a function, it indicates that calls to
1321 this function should not be made control-dependent on additional values.
Justin Bognera4635372016-07-06 20:02:45 +00001322 For example, the intrinsic ``llvm.nvvm.barrier0`` is ``convergent``, so
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001323 calls to this intrinsic cannot be made control-dependent on additional
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001324 values.
Justin Lebard5fb6952016-02-09 23:03:17 +00001325
Justin Lebar58535b12016-02-17 17:46:41 +00001326 When it appears on a call/invoke, the ``convergent`` attribute indicates
1327 that we should treat the call as though we're calling a convergent
1328 function. This is particularly useful on indirect calls; without this we
1329 may treat such calls as though the target is non-convergent.
1330
1331 The optimizer may remove the ``convergent`` attribute on functions when it
1332 can prove that the function does not execute any convergent operations.
1333 Similarly, the optimizer may remove ``convergent`` on calls/invokes when it
1334 can prove that the call/invoke cannot call a convergent function.
Vaivaswatha Nagarajfb3f4902015-12-16 16:16:19 +00001335``inaccessiblememonly``
1336 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
1337 is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
1338 of ``readnone``.
1339``inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly``
1340 This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
1341 either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
1342 by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of ``argmemonly``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001343``inlinehint``
1344 This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that
1345 inlining this function is desirable (such as the "inline" keyword in
1346 C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the
1347 inliner.
Tom Roeder44cb65f2014-06-05 19:29:43 +00001348``jumptable``
1349 This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
1350 jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
1351 references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
1352 appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
1353 a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
1354 on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
1355 ``jumptable`` must also be ``unnamed_addr``.
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001356``minsize``
1357 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1358 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001359 as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001360 performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001361``naked``
1362 This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the
1363 function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
Eli Bendersky97ad9242013-04-18 16:11:44 +00001364``nobuiltin``
Michael Gottesman41748d72013-06-27 00:25:01 +00001365 This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
1366 a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
1367 with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
1368 the call site uses the ``builtin`` attribute. This is valid at call sites
1369 and on function declarations and definitions.
Bill Wendlingbf902f12013-02-06 06:22:58 +00001370``noduplicate``
1371 This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be
1372 duplicated. A call to a ``noduplicate`` function may be moved
1373 within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within
1374 its parent function.
1375
1376 A function containing a ``noduplicate`` call may still
1377 be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not
1378 duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has
1379 internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original
1380 call is dead after inlining.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001381``noimplicitfloat``
1382 This attributes disables implicit floating point instructions.
1383``noinline``
1384 This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
1385 function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
1386 with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute.
Sean Silva1cbbcf12013-08-06 19:34:37 +00001387``nonlazybind``
1388 This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This
1389 may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program
1390 startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001391``noredzone``
1392 This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a
1393 red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
1394``noreturn``
1395 This function attribute indicates that the function never returns
1396 normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the
1397 function ever does dynamically return.
James Molloye6f87ca2015-11-06 10:32:53 +00001398``norecurse``
1399 This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself
1400 either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces
1401 undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001402``nounwind``
Reid Kleckner96d01132015-02-11 01:23:16 +00001403 This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an
1404 exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime
1405 behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still
1406 trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes
1407 that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such
1408 as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001409``optnone``
Paul Robinsona2550a62015-11-30 21:56:16 +00001410 This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip
1411 this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes.
1412 Code generation defaults to the "fast" instruction selector.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001413 This attribute cannot be used together with the ``alwaysinline``
1414 attribute; this attribute is also incompatible
1415 with the ``minsize`` attribute and the ``optsize`` attribute.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001416
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001417 This attribute requires the ``noinline`` attribute to be specified on
1418 the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller.
Andrea Di Biagio377496b2013-08-23 11:53:55 +00001419 Only functions with the ``alwaysinline`` attribute are valid
Paul Robinsondcbe35b2013-11-18 21:44:03 +00001420 candidates for inlining into the body of this function.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001421``optsize``
1422 This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator
1423 passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low,
Andrea Di Biagio9b5d23b2013-08-09 18:42:18 +00001424 and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as
1425 long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
Sanjoy Dasc0441c22016-04-19 05:24:47 +00001426``"patchable-function"``
1427 This attribute tells the code generator that the code
1428 generated for this function needs to follow certain conventions that
1429 make it possible for a runtime function to patch over it later.
1430 The exact effect of this attribute depends on its string value,
Sylvestre Ledru7d540502016-07-02 19:28:40 +00001431 for which there currently is one legal possibility:
Sanjoy Dasc0441c22016-04-19 05:24:47 +00001432
1433 * ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` - This style of patchable
1434 function is intended to support patching a function prologue to
1435 redirect control away from the function in a thread safe
1436 manner. It guarantees that the first instruction of the
1437 function will be large enough to accommodate a short jump
1438 instruction, and will be sufficiently aligned to allow being
1439 fully changed via an atomic compare-and-swap instruction.
1440 While the first requirement can be satisfied by inserting large
1441 enough NOP, LLVM can and will try to re-purpose an existing
1442 instruction (i.e. one that would have to be emitted anyway) as
1443 the patchable instruction larger than a short jump.
1444
1445 ``"prologue-short-redirect"`` is currently only supported on
1446 x86-64.
1447
1448 This attribute by itself does not imply restrictions on
1449 inter-procedural optimizations. All of the semantic effects the
1450 patching may have to be separately conveyed via the linkage type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001451``readnone``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001452 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its
1453 result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments,
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001454 without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing
1455 any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1456 caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments
1457 (including ``byval`` arguments) and never changes any state visible
1458 to callers. This means that it cannot unwind exceptions by calling
1459 the ``C++`` exception throwing methods.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001460
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001461 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not
1462 dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the
Nick Lewyckyefe31f22013-07-06 01:04:47 +00001463 memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001464``readonly``
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001465 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1466 through any pointer arguments (including ``byval`` arguments) or otherwise
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001467 modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to
1468 caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read
1469 state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always
1470 returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when
1471 called with the same set of arguments and global state. It cannot
1472 unwind an exception by calling the ``C++`` exception throwing
1473 methods.
Andrew Trickd4d1d9c2013-10-31 17:18:07 +00001474
Nick Lewyckyc2ec0722013-07-06 00:29:58 +00001475 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write
1476 through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that
1477 the pointer points to.
Nicolai Haehnle84c9f992016-07-04 08:01:29 +00001478``writeonly``
1479 On a function, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1480 does not read from memory.
1481
1482 On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function may write to but
1483 does not read through this pointer argument (even though it may read from
1484 the memory that the pointer points to).
Igor Laevsky39d662f2015-07-11 10:30:36 +00001485``argmemonly``
1486 This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
1487 loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
1488 with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
1489 function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
1490 arguments.
1491 Note that ``argmemonly`` can be used together with ``readonly`` attribute
1492 in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001493``returns_twice``
1494 This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
1495 ``setjmp`` is an example of such a function. The compiler disables
1496 some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these
1497 functions.
Peter Collingbourne82437bf2015-06-15 21:07:11 +00001498``safestack``
1499 This attribute indicates that
1500 `SafeStack <http://clang.llvm.org/docs/SafeStack.html>`_
1501 protection is enabled for this function.
1502
1503 If a function that has a ``safestack`` attribute is inlined into a
1504 function that doesn't have a ``safestack`` attribute or which has an
1505 ``ssp``, ``sspstrong`` or ``sspreq`` attribute, then the resulting
1506 function will have a ``safestack`` attribute.
Kostya Serebryanycf880b92013-02-26 06:58:09 +00001507``sanitize_address``
1508 This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks
1509 (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
1510``sanitize_memory``
1511 This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection
1512 of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
1513``sanitize_thread``
1514 This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks
1515 (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001516``ssp``
1517 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00001518 smashing protector. It is in the form of a "canary" --- a random value
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001519 placed on the stack before the local variables that's checked upon
1520 return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A
1521 heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001522 or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001523
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001524 - Character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size`` (default 8).
1525 - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than ``ssp-buffer-size``.
1526 - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
1527 ``ssp-buffer-size``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001528
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001529 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1530 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1531
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001532 If a function that has an ``ssp`` attribute is inlined into a
1533 function that doesn't have an ``ssp`` attribute, then the resulting
1534 function will have an ``ssp`` attribute.
1535``sspreq``
1536 This attribute indicates that the function should *always* emit a
1537 stack smashing protector. This overrides the ``ssp`` function
1538 attribute.
1539
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001540 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1541 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1542 The specific layout rules are:
1543
1544 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1545 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1546 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1547 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1548 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1549 protector.
1550
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001551 If a function that has an ``sspreq`` attribute is inlined into a
1552 function that doesn't have an ``sspreq`` attribute or which has an
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001553 ``ssp`` or ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the resulting function will have
1554 an ``sspreq`` attribute.
1555``sspstrong``
1556 This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001557 protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001558 determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001559 will enable protectors for functions with:
Dmitri Gribenko69b56472013-01-29 23:14:41 +00001560
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001561 - Arrays of any size and type
1562 - Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
1563 - Calls to alloca().
1564 - Local variables that have had their address taken.
1565
Josh Magee24c7f062014-02-01 01:36:16 +00001566 Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged
1567 on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
1568 The specific layout rules are:
1569
1570 #. Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
1571 (``>= ssp-buffer-size``) are closest to the stack protector.
1572 #. Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
1573 (``< ssp-buffer-size``) are 2nd closest to the protector.
1574 #. Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the
1575 protector.
1576
Bill Wendling7c8f96a2013-01-23 06:43:53 +00001577 This overrides the ``ssp`` function attribute.
Bill Wendlingd154e2832013-01-23 06:41:41 +00001578
1579 If a function that has an ``sspstrong`` attribute is inlined into a
1580 function that doesn't have an ``sspstrong`` attribute, then the
1581 resulting function will have an ``sspstrong`` attribute.
Reid Kleckner5a2ab2b2015-03-04 00:08:56 +00001582``"thunk"``
1583 This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other
1584 function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for
1585 optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to
1586 match the thunk target prototype.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001587``uwtable``
1588 This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001589 an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001590 show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for
1591 the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation
1592 units.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001593
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001594
1595.. _opbundles:
1596
1597Operand Bundles
1598---------------
1599
1600Note: operand bundles are a work in progress, and they should be
1601considered experimental at this time.
1602
1603Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
Sanjoy Dasb0e9d4a52015-09-25 00:05:40 +00001604with certain LLVM instructions (currently only ``call`` s and
1605``invoke`` s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001606incorrect and will change program semantics.
1607
1608Syntax::
David Majnemer34cacb42015-10-22 01:46:38 +00001609
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001610 operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001611 operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
1612 bundle operand ::= SSA value
1613 tag ::= string constant
1614
1615Operand bundles are **not** part of a function's signature, and a
1616given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
1617of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
1618are conceptually a part of the ``call`` (or ``invoke``), not the
1619callee being dispatched to.
1620
1621Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support
1622runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While
1623the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag,
1624there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand
1625bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions
1626are described as the semantics of an "unknown" operand bundle. As
1627long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these
1628restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the
1629operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
1630
David Majnemer34cacb42015-10-22 01:46:38 +00001631- The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown
1632 ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
1633- Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
1634 effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
Sylvestre Ledru84666a12016-02-14 20:16:22 +00001635 ``readnone`` or ``readonly``), unless they're overridden with
Sanjoy Das98a341b2015-10-22 03:12:22 +00001636 callsite specific attributes.
1637- An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation
1638 of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as
1639 usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00001640
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001641More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
1642
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +00001643.. _deopt_opbundles:
1644
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001645Deoptimization Operand Bundles
1646^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1647
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001648Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the ``"deopt"``
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001649operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
1650"safe" continuation for the call site they're attached to, and can be
1651used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
Sanjoy Das9f3c1252015-11-21 09:12:07 +00001652specified call site. There can be at most one ``"deopt"`` operand
1653bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
1654out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
1655rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
Sanjoy Dascdafd842015-11-11 21:38:02 +00001656
1657From the compiler's perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
1658the call sites they're attached to at least ``readonly``. They read
1659through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they're not
1660otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
1661operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
1662deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
1663compiled frame.
1664
Sanjoy Das2d161452015-11-18 06:23:38 +00001665The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
1666operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
1667involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
1668through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
1669appropriately compose the "safe" deoptimization continuation. The
1670inliner does this by prepending the parent's deoptimization
1671continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
1672E.g. inlining ``@f`` into ``@g`` in the following example
1673
1674.. code-block:: llvm
1675
1676 define void @f() {
1677 call void @x() ;; no deopt state
1678 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
1679 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1680 ret void
1681 }
1682
1683 define void @g() {
1684 call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
1685 ret void
1686 }
1687
1688will result in
1689
1690.. code-block:: llvm
1691
1692 define void @g() {
1693 call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
1694 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
1695 call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
1696 ret void
1697 }
1698
1699It is the frontend's responsibility to structure or encode the
1700deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the
1701caller's deoptimization state to the callee's deoptimization state is
1702semantically equivalent to composing the caller's deoptimization
1703continuation after the callee's deoptimization continuation.
1704
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00001705.. _ob_funclet:
1706
David Majnemer3bb88c02015-12-15 21:27:27 +00001707Funclet Operand Bundles
1708^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1709
1710Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the ``"funclet"``
1711operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site
1712is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one
1713``"funclet"`` operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
1714exactly one bundle operand.
1715
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00001716If any funclet EH pads have been "entered" but not "exited" (per the
1717`description in the EH doc\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
1718it is undefined behavior to execute a ``call`` or ``invoke`` which:
1719
1720* does not have a ``"funclet"`` bundle and is not a ``call`` to a nounwind
1721 intrinsic, or
1722* has a ``"funclet"`` bundle whose operand is not the most-recently-entered
1723 not-yet-exited funclet EH pad.
1724
1725Similarly, if no funclet EH pads have been entered-but-not-yet-exited,
1726executing a ``call`` or ``invoke`` with a ``"funclet"`` bundle is undefined behavior.
1727
Sanjoy Dasa34ce952016-01-20 19:50:25 +00001728GC Transition Operand Bundles
1729^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
1730
1731GC transition operand bundles are characterized by the
1732``"gc-transition"`` operand bundle tag. These operand bundles mark a
1733call as a transition between a function with one GC strategy to a
1734function with a different GC strategy. If coordinating the transition
1735between GC strategies requires additional code generation at the call
1736site, these bundles may contain any values that are needed by the
1737generated code. For more details, see :ref:`GC Transitions
1738<gc_transition_args>`.
1739
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001740.. _moduleasm:
1741
1742Module-Level Inline Assembly
1743----------------------------
1744
1745Modules may contain "module-level inline asm" blocks, which corresponds
1746to the GCC "file scope inline asm" blocks. These blocks are internally
1747concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
1748in the ``.ll`` file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
1749
1750.. code-block:: llvm
1751
1752 module asm "inline asm code goes here"
1753 module asm "more can go here"
1754
1755The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable
1756characters. The escape sequence used is simply "\\xx" where "xx" is the
1757two digit hex code for the number.
1758
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00001759Note that the assembly string *must* be parseable by LLVM's integrated assembler
1760(unless it is disabled), even when emitting a ``.s`` file.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001761
Eli Benderskyfdc529a2013-06-07 19:40:08 +00001762.. _langref_datalayout:
1763
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001764Data Layout
1765-----------
1766
1767A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies
1768how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is
1769simply:
1770
1771.. code-block:: llvm
1772
1773 target datalayout = "layout specification"
1774
1775The *layout specification* consists of a list of specifications
1776separated by the minus sign character ('-'). Each specification starts
1777with a letter and may include other information after the letter to
1778define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are
1779as follows:
1780
1781``E``
1782 Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is,
1783 the bits with the most significance have the lowest address
1784 location.
1785``e``
1786 Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That
1787 is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address
1788 location.
1789``S<size>``
1790 Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment
1791 promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack
1792 alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment
1793 must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack
1794 alignment defaults to "unspecified", which does not prevent any
1795 alignment promotions.
1796``p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1797 This specifies the *size* of a pointer and its ``<abi>`` and
1798 ``<pref>``\erred alignments for address space ``n``. All sizes are in
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001799 bits. The address space, ``n``, is optional, and if not specified,
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00001800 denotes the default address space 0. The value of ``n`` must be
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001801 in the range [1,2^23).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001802``i<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1803 This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
1804 ``<size>``. The value of ``<size>`` must be in the range [1,2^23).
1805``v<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1806 This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
1807 ``<size>``.
1808``f<size>:<abi>:<pref>``
1809 This specifies the alignment for a floating point type of a given bit
1810 ``<size>``. Only values of ``<size>`` that are supported by the target
1811 will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80
1812 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some
1813 targets.
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001814``a:<abi>:<pref>``
1815 This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
Rafael Espindola58873562014-01-03 19:21:54 +00001816``m:<mangling>``
Hans Wennborgd4245ac2014-01-15 02:49:17 +00001817 If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. The
1818 options are
1819
1820 * ``e``: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a ``.L`` prefix.
1821 * ``m``: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a ``$`` prefix.
1822 * ``o``: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols get ``L`` prefix. Other
1823 symbols get a ``_`` prefix.
1824 * ``w``: Windows COFF prefix: Similar to Mach-O, but stdcall and fastcall
1825 functions also get a suffix based on the frame size.
Saleem Abdulrasool70d2d642015-10-25 20:39:35 +00001826 * ``x``: Windows x86 COFF prefix: Similar to Windows COFF, but use a ``_``
1827 prefix for ``__cdecl`` functions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001828``n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...``
1829 This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
1830 bits. For example, it might contain ``n32`` for 32-bit PowerPC,
1831 ``n32:64`` for PowerPC 64, or ``n8:16:32:64`` for X86-64. Elements of
1832 this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations
1833 efficiently.
1834
Rafael Espindolaabdd7262014-01-06 21:40:24 +00001835On every specification that takes a ``<abi>:<pref>``, specifying the
1836``<pref>`` alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding ``:``
1837should be omitted too and ``<pref>`` will be equal to ``<abi>``.
1838
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001839When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
1840default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
1841the specifications in the ``datalayout`` keyword. The default
1842specifications are given in this list:
1843
1844- ``E`` - big endian
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00001845- ``p:64:64:64`` - 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.
1846- ``p[n]:64:64:64`` - Other address spaces are assumed to be the
1847 same as the default address space.
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001848- ``S0`` - natural stack alignment is unspecified
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001849- ``i1:8:8`` - i1 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
1850- ``i8:8:8`` - i8 is 8-bit (byte) aligned
1851- ``i16:16:16`` - i16 is 16-bit aligned
1852- ``i32:32:32`` - i32 is 32-bit aligned
1853- ``i64:32:64`` - i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred
1854 alignment of 64-bits
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001855- ``f16:16:16`` - half is 16-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001856- ``f32:32:32`` - float is 32-bit aligned
1857- ``f64:64:64`` - double is 64-bit aligned
Patrik Hagglunda832ab12013-01-30 09:02:06 +00001858- ``f128:128:128`` - quad is 128-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001859- ``v64:64:64`` - 64-bit vector is 64-bit aligned
1860- ``v128:128:128`` - 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligned
Rafael Espindolae8f4d582013-12-12 17:21:51 +00001861- ``a:0:64`` - aggregates are 64-bit aligned
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001862
1863When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the
1864following rules:
1865
1866#. If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications,
1867 that specification is used.
1868#. If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then
1869 the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the
1870 sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than
1871 the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example,
1872 given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the
1873 alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the
1874 alignment of i64 (largest specified).
1875#. If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the
1876 largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will
1877 be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be
1878 implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
1879
1880The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect.
1881Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment
1882the code generator should use.
1883
1884Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what
1885the ultimate *code generator* expects. This string is used by the
1886mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00001887what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR
1888that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you
1889don't specify the string, the default specifications will be used to
1890generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate
1891accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to
1892these default specifications.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001893
Bill Wendling5cc90842013-10-18 23:41:25 +00001894.. _langref_triple:
1895
1896Target Triple
1897-------------
1898
1899A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target
1900host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
1901
1902.. code-block:: llvm
1903
1904 target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
1905
1906The *target triple* string consists of a series of identifiers delimited
1907by the minus sign character ('-'). The canonical forms are:
1908
1909::
1910
1911 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
1912 ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
1913
1914This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
1915code for the proper architecture. It's possible to override this on the
1916command line with the ``-mtriple`` command line option.
1917
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001918.. _pointeraliasing:
1919
1920Pointer Aliasing Rules
1921----------------------
1922
1923Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with
1924an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is
1925undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according
1926to the following rules:
1927
1928- A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any
1929 value it is *based* on.
1930- An address of a global variable is associated with the address range
1931 of the variable's storage.
1932- The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the
1933 address range of the allocated storage.
1934- A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no
1935 address.
1936- An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from
1937 a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address
1938 ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by
1939 LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses
1940 allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
1941
1942A pointer value is *based* on another pointer value according to the
1943following rules:
1944
1945- A pointer value formed from a ``getelementptr`` operation is *based*
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00001946 on the first value operand of the ``getelementptr``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001947- The result value of a ``bitcast`` is *based* on the operand of the
1948 ``bitcast``.
1949- A pointer value formed by an ``inttoptr`` is *based* on all pointer
1950 values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of
1951 the pointer's value.
1952- The "*based* on" relationship is transitive.
1953
1954Note that this definition of *"based"* is intentionally similar to the
1955definition of *"based"* in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
1956
1957LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
1958``load`` merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
1959which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
1960operand type of a ``store`` similarly only indicates the size and
1961alignment of the store.
1962
1963Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
1964``-fstrict-aliasing``, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
1965:ref:`Metadata <metadata>` may be used to encode additional information
1966which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
1967alias analysis.
1968
1969.. _volatile:
1970
1971Volatile Memory Accesses
1972------------------------
1973
1974Certain memory accesses, such as :ref:`load <i_load>`'s,
1975:ref:`store <i_store>`'s, and :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`'s may be
1976marked ``volatile``. The optimizers must not change the number of
1977volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
1978volatile operations. The optimizers *may* change the order of volatile
1979operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java's
1980"volatile" and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
1981
Andrew Trick89fc5a62013-01-30 21:19:35 +00001982IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into
1983llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are
1984flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge
1985target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
1986
Andrew Trick7e6f9282013-01-31 00:49:39 +00001987.. admonition:: Rationale
1988
1989 Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported
1990 data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C
1991 this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native
1992 hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The
1993 frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00001994 unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations
Andrew Trick7e6f9282013-01-31 00:49:39 +00001995 do not violate the frontend's contract with the language.
1996
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00001997.. _memmodel:
1998
1999Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
2000--------------------------------------
2001
2002The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of
2003execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are
2004platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR's behavior
2005in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
2006
2007For a more informal introduction to this model, see the :doc:`Atomics`.
2008
2009We define a *happens-before* partial order as the least partial order
2010that
2011
2012- Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
2013- When a *synchronizes-with* ``b``, includes an edge from ``a`` to
2014 ``b``. *Synchronizes-with* pairs are introduced by platform-specific
2015 techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining,
2016 etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also :ref:`Atomic Memory Ordering
2017 Constraints <ordering>`).
2018
2019Note that program order does not introduce *happens-before* edges
2020between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
2021
2022Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic
2023loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by
2024(defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic
2025stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this
2026section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the
2027initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write
2028of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, R\ :sub:`byte`
2029may see any write to the same byte, except:
2030
2031- If write\ :sub:`1` happens before write\ :sub:`2`, and
2032 write\ :sub:`2` happens before R\ :sub:`byte`, then
2033 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`1`.
2034- If R\ :sub:`byte` happens before write\ :sub:`3`, then
2035 R\ :sub:`byte` does not see write\ :sub:`3`.
2036
2037Given that definition, R\ :sub:`byte` is defined as follows:
2038
2039- If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
2040 supposed to give guarantees which can support ``sig_atomic_t`` in
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002041 C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002042 like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread
2043 synchronization.)
2044- Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
2045 R\ :sub:`byte`, R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef`` for that byte.
2046- Otherwise, if R\ :sub:`byte` may see exactly one write,
2047 R\ :sub:`byte` returns the value written by that write.
2048- Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes R\ :sub:`byte` may
2049 see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the :ref:`Atomic
2050 Memory Ordering Constraints <ordering>` section for additional
2051 constraints on how the choice is made.
2052- Otherwise R\ :sub:`byte` returns ``undef``.
2053
2054R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
2055implies that some bytes within the value may be ``undef`` **without**
2056the entire value being ``undef``. Note that this only defines the
2057semantics of the operation; it doesn't mean that targets will emit more
2058than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
2059
2060Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this
2061model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what
2062is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte
2063which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general.
2064(Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read
2065from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see
2066exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
2067
2068.. _ordering:
2069
2070Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
2071----------------------------------
2072
2073Atomic instructions (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>`,
2074:ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`, :ref:`fence <i_fence>`,
2075:ref:`atomic load <i_load>`, and :ref:`atomic store <i_store>`) take
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00002076ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002077the same address they *synchronize with*. These semantics are borrowed
2078from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these
2079descriptions aren't precise enough, check those specs (see spec
2080references in the :doc:`atomics guide <Atomics>`).
2081:ref:`fence <i_fence>` instructions treat these orderings somewhat
2082differently since they don't take an address. See that instruction's
2083documentation for details.
2084
2085For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the
2086:doc:`Atomics`.
2087
2088``unordered``
2089 The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before
2090 partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote
2091 it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model
2092 Java's non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be
2093 specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough
2094 to make them atomic in any interesting way.
2095``monotonic``
2096 In addition to the guarantees of ``unordered``, there is a single
2097 total order for modifications by ``monotonic`` operations on each
2098 address. All modification orders must be compatible with the
2099 happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification
2100 orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program
2101 (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic
2102 read-modify-write operation (:ref:`cmpxchg <i_cmpxchg>` and
2103 :ref:`atomicrmw <i_atomicrmw>`) reads the value in the modification
2104 order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read
2105 happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later
2106 read must see the same value or a later value in the address's
2107 modification order. This disallows reordering of ``monotonic`` (or
2108 stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is written
2109 ``monotonic``-ally by one thread, and other threads ``monotonic``-ally
2110 read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see
2111 the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2112 ``memory_order_relaxed``.
2113``acquire``
2114 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, a
2115 *synchronizes-with* edge may be formed with a ``release`` operation.
2116 This is intended to model C++'s ``memory_order_acquire``.
2117``release``
2118 In addition to the guarantees of ``monotonic``, if this operation
2119 writes a value which is subsequently read by an ``acquire``
2120 operation, it *synchronizes-with* that operation. (This isn't a
2121 complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release
2122 sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2123 ``memory_order_release``.
2124``acq_rel`` (acquire+release)
2125 Acts as both an ``acquire`` and ``release`` operation on its
2126 address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x ``memory_order_acq_rel``.
2127``seq_cst`` (sequentially consistent)
2128 In addition to the guarantees of ``acq_rel`` (``acquire`` for an
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002129 operation that only reads, ``release`` for an operation that only
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002130 writes), there is a global total order on all
2131 sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is
2132 consistent with the *happens-before* partial order and with the
2133 modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each
2134 sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the
2135 same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1x
2136 ``memory_order_seq_cst`` and Java volatile.
2137
2138.. _singlethread:
2139
2140If an atomic operation is marked ``singlethread``, it only *synchronizes
2141with* or participates in modification and seq\_cst total orderings with
2142other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal
2143handlers).
2144
2145.. _fastmath:
2146
2147Fast-Math Flags
2148---------------
2149
2150LLVM IR floating-point binary ops (:ref:`fadd <i_fadd>`,
2151:ref:`fsub <i_fsub>`, :ref:`fmul <i_fmul>`, :ref:`fdiv <i_fdiv>`,
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00002152:ref:`frem <i_frem>`, :ref:`fcmp <i_fcmp>`) have the following flags that can
2153be set to enable otherwise unsafe floating point operations
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002154
2155``nnan``
2156 No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2157 NaN. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
2158 NaNs, but the value of the result is undefined.
2159
2160``ninf``
2161 No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not
2162 +/-Inf. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over
2163 +/-Inf, but the value of the result is undefined.
2164
2165``nsz``
2166 No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero
2167 argument or result as insignificant.
2168
2169``arcp``
2170 Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an
2171 argument rather than perform division.
2172
2173``fast``
2174 Fast - Allow algebraically equivalent transformations that may
2175 dramatically change results in floating point (e.g. reassociate). This
2176 flag implies all the others.
2177
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002178.. _uselistorder:
2179
2180Use-list Order Directives
2181-------------------------
2182
2183Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002184order to be recreated. ``<order-indexes>`` is a comma-separated list of
2185indexes that are assigned to the referenced value's uses. The referenced
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002186value's use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
2187
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002188Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not
2189instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they're at
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002190function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
2191
2192If basic blocks have their address taken via ``blockaddress()`` expressions,
2193``uselistorder_bb`` can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
2194function's scope.
2195
2196:Syntax:
2197
2198::
2199
2200 uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
2201 uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
2202
2203:Examples:
2204
2205::
2206
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith23046652014-08-19 21:48:04 +00002207 define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
2208 entry:
2209 ; ... instructions ...
2210 bb:
2211 ; ... instructions ...
2212
2213 ; At function scope.
2214 uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
2215 uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
2216 }
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith0a448fb2014-08-19 21:30:15 +00002217
2218 ; At global scope.
2219 uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
2220 uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
2221 uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
2222 uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
2223
Teresa Johnsonde9b8b42016-04-22 13:09:17 +00002224.. _source_filename:
2225
2226Source Filename
2227---------------
2228
2229The *source filename* string is set to the original module identifier,
2230which will be the name of the compiled source file when compiling from
2231source through the clang front end, for example. It is then preserved through
2232the IR and bitcode.
2233
2234This is currently necessary to generate a consistent unique global
2235identifier for local functions used in profile data, which prepends the
2236source file name to the local function name.
2237
2238The syntax for the source file name is simply:
2239
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00002240.. code-block:: text
Teresa Johnsonde9b8b42016-04-22 13:09:17 +00002241
2242 source_filename = "/path/to/source.c"
2243
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002244.. _typesystem:
2245
2246Type System
2247===========
2248
2249The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the
2250intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of
2251optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation
2252directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the
2253transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the
2254generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are
2255not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
2256
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002257.. _t_void:
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002258
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002259Void Type
2260---------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002261
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002262:Overview:
2263
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002264
2265The void type does not represent any value and has no size.
2266
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002267:Syntax:
2268
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002269
2270::
2271
2272 void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002273
2274
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002275.. _t_function:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002276
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002277Function Type
2278-------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002279
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002280:Overview:
2281
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002282
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002283The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a
2284return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function
2285type is a void type or first class type --- except for :ref:`label <t_label>`
2286and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>` types.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002287
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002288:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002289
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002290::
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002291
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002292 <returntype> (<parameter list>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002293
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002294...where '``<parameter list>``' is a comma-separated list of type
2295specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ``...``, which
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002296indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002297argument functions can access their arguments with the :ref:`variable argument
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002298handling intrinsic <int_varargs>` functions. '``<returntype>``' is any type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002299except :ref:`label <t_label>` and :ref:`metadata <t_metadata>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002300
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002301:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002302
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002303+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2304| ``i32 (i32)`` | function taking an ``i32``, returning an ``i32`` |
2305+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2306| ``float (i16, i32 *) *`` | :ref:`Pointer <t_pointer>` to a function that takes an ``i16`` and a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i32``, returning ``float``. |
2307+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2308| ``i32 (i8*, ...)`` | A vararg function that takes at least one :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to ``i8`` (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for ``printf`` in LLVM. |
2309+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2310| ``{i32, i32} (i32)`` | A function taking an ``i32``, returning a :ref:`structure <t_struct>` containing two ``i32`` values |
2311+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2312
2313.. _t_firstclass:
2314
2315First Class Types
2316-----------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002317
2318The :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` types are perhaps the most important.
2319Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by
2320instructions.
2321
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002322.. _t_single_value:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002323
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002324Single Value Types
2325^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002326
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002327These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen's perspective.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002328
2329.. _t_integer:
2330
2331Integer Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002332""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002333
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002334:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002335
2336The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an
2337arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1
2338bit to 2\ :sup:`23`\ -1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
2339
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002340:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002341
2342::
2343
2344 iN
2345
2346The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the ``N``
2347value.
2348
2349Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002350*********
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002351
2352+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2353| ``i1`` | a single-bit integer. |
2354+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2355| ``i32`` | a 32-bit integer. |
2356+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2357| ``i1942652`` | a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
2358+----------------+------------------------------------------------+
2359
2360.. _t_floating:
2361
2362Floating Point Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002363""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002364
2365.. list-table::
2366 :header-rows: 1
2367
2368 * - Type
2369 - Description
2370
2371 * - ``half``
2372 - 16-bit floating point value
2373
2374 * - ``float``
2375 - 32-bit floating point value
2376
2377 * - ``double``
2378 - 64-bit floating point value
2379
2380 * - ``fp128``
2381 - 128-bit floating point value (112-bit mantissa)
2382
2383 * - ``x86_fp80``
2384 - 80-bit floating point value (X87)
2385
2386 * - ``ppc_fp128``
2387 - 128-bit floating point value (two 64-bits)
2388
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002389X86_mmx Type
2390""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002391
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002392:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002393
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002394The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002395machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and
2396return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX
2397instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments
2398and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants
2399of this type.
2400
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002401:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002402
2403::
2404
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002405 x86_mmx
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002406
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002407
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002408.. _t_pointer:
2409
2410Pointer Type
2411""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002412
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002413:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002414
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002415The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are
2416commonly used to reference objects in memory.
2417
2418Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the
2419numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default
2420address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces
2421are target-specific.
2422
2423Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (``void*``) nor does it
2424permit pointers to labels (``label*``). Use ``i8*`` instead.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002425
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002426:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002427
2428::
2429
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002430 <type> *
2431
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002432:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002433
2434+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2435| ``[4 x i32]*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to :ref:`array <t_array>` of four ``i32`` values. |
2436+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2437| ``i32 (i32*) *`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32*``, returning an ``i32``. |
2438+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2439| ``i32 addrspace(5)*`` | A :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to an ``i32`` value that resides in address space #5. |
2440+-------------------------+--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2441
2442.. _t_vector:
2443
2444Vector Type
2445"""""""""""
2446
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002447:Overview:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002448
2449A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of
2450elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are
2451operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type
2452requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data
2453type. Vector types are considered :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>`.
2454
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002455:Syntax:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002456
2457::
2458
2459 < <# elements> x <elementtype> >
2460
2461The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0;
Manuel Jacob961f7872014-07-30 12:30:06 +00002462elementtype may be any integer, floating point or pointer type. Vectors
2463of size zero are not allowed.
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002464
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002465:Examples:
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002466
2467+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2468| ``<4 x i32>`` | Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
2469+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2470| ``<8 x float>`` | Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
2471+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2472| ``<2 x i64>`` | Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
2473+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
2474| ``<4 x i64*>`` | Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
2475+-------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002476
2477.. _t_label:
2478
2479Label Type
2480^^^^^^^^^^
2481
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002482:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002483
2484The label type represents code labels.
2485
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002486:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002487
2488::
2489
2490 label
2491
David Majnemerb611e3f2015-08-14 05:09:07 +00002492.. _t_token:
2493
2494Token Type
2495^^^^^^^^^^
2496
2497:Overview:
2498
2499The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction
2500but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it.
2501As such, it is not appropriate to have a :ref:`phi <i_phi>` or
2502:ref:`select <i_select>` of type token.
2503
2504:Syntax:
2505
2506::
2507
2508 token
2509
2510
2511
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002512.. _t_metadata:
2513
2514Metadata Type
2515^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2516
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002517:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002518
2519The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be
2520created from metadata except for :ref:`function <t_function>` arguments.
2521
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002522:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002523
2524::
2525
2526 metadata
2527
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002528.. _t_aggregate:
2529
2530Aggregate Types
2531^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
2532
2533Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple
2534member types. :ref:`Arrays <t_array>` and :ref:`structs <t_struct>` are
2535aggregate types. :ref:`Vectors <t_vector>` are not considered to be
2536aggregate types.
2537
2538.. _t_array:
2539
2540Array Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002541""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002542
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002543:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002544
2545The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements
2546sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of
2547elements) and an underlying data type.
2548
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002549:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002550
2551::
2552
2553 [<# elements> x <elementtype>]
2554
2555The number of elements is a constant integer value; ``elementtype`` may
2556be any type with a size.
2557
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002558:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002559
2560+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2561| ``[40 x i32]`` | Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
2562+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2563| ``[41 x i32]`` | Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
2564+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2565| ``[4 x i8]`` | Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
2566+------------------+--------------------------------------+
2567
2568Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
2569
2570+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2571| ``[3 x [4 x i32]]`` | 3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
2572+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2573| ``[12 x [10 x float]]`` | 12x10 array of single precision floating point values. |
2574+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2575| ``[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]]`` | 2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
2576+-----------------------------+----------------------------------------------------------+
2577
2578There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
2579by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
2580bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
2581single-dimension 'variable sized array' addressing can be implemented in
2582LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of 'pascal style
2583arrays' in LLVM could use the type "``{ i32, [0 x float]}``", for
2584example.
2585
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002586.. _t_struct:
2587
2588Structure Type
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002589""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002590
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002591:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002592
2593The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members
2594together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has
2595a size.
2596
2597Structures in memory are accessed using '``load``' and '``store``' by
2598getting a pointer to a field with the '``getelementptr``' instruction.
2599Structures in registers are accessed using the '``extractvalue``' and
2600'``insertvalue``' instructions.
2601
2602Structures may optionally be "packed" structures, which indicate that
2603the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding
2604between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types
2605is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is
2606required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
2607
2608Structures can either be "literal" or "identified". A literal structure
2609is defined inline with other types (e.g. ``{i32, i32}*``) whereas
2610identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
2611Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
2612or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
2613recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
2614
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002615:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002616
2617::
2618
2619 %T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
2620 %T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
2621
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002622:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002623
2624+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2625| ``{ i32, i32, i32 }`` | A triple of three ``i32`` values |
2626+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00002627| ``{ float, i32 (i32) * }`` | A pair, where the first element is a ``float`` and the second element is a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` to a :ref:`function <t_function>` that takes an ``i32``, returning an ``i32``. |
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002628+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2629| ``<{ i8, i32 }>`` | A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
2630+------------------------------+---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
2631
2632.. _t_opaque:
2633
2634Opaque Structure Types
Rafael Espindola08013342013-12-07 19:34:20 +00002635""""""""""""""""""""""
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002636
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002637:Overview:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002638
2639Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that
2640do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C
2641notion of a forward declared structure.
2642
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002643:Syntax:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002644
2645::
2646
2647 %X = type opaque
2648 %52 = type opaque
2649
Rafael Espindola2f6d7b92013-12-10 14:53:22 +00002650:Examples:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002651
2652+--------------+-------------------+
2653| ``opaque`` | An opaque type. |
2654+--------------+-------------------+
2655
Sean Silva1703e702014-04-08 21:06:22 +00002656.. _constants:
2657
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002658Constants
2659=========
2660
2661LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section
2662describes them all and their syntax.
2663
2664Simple Constants
2665----------------
2666
2667**Boolean constants**
2668 The two strings '``true``' and '``false``' are both valid constants
2669 of the ``i1`` type.
2670**Integer constants**
2671 Standard integers (such as '4') are constants of the
2672 :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. Negative numbers may be used with
2673 integer types.
2674**Floating point constants**
2675 Floating point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g.
2676 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise
2677 hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact
2678 decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the
2679 assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating
2680 decimal in binary. Floating point constants must have a :ref:`floating
2681 point <t_floating>` type.
2682**Null pointer constants**
2683 The identifier '``null``' is recognized as a null pointer constant
2684 and must be of :ref:`pointer type <t_pointer>`.
David Majnemerf0f224d2015-11-11 21:57:16 +00002685**Token constants**
2686 The identifier '``none``' is recognized as an empty token constant
2687 and must be of :ref:`token type <t_token>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002688
2689The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
2690floating point constants. For example, the form
2691'``double 0x432ff973cafa8000``' is equivalent to (but harder to read
2692than) '``double 4.5e+15``'. The only time hexadecimal floating point
2693constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
2694disassembler) is when a floating point constant must be emitted but it
2695cannot be represented as a decimal floating point number in a reasonable
2696number of digits. For example, NaN's, infinities, and other special
2697values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
2698and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
2699
2700When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
2701double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
2702matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
Dmitri Gribenko4dc2ba12013-01-16 23:40:37 +00002703must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002704precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
2705double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
2706by x86 is represented as ``0xK`` followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
2707128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
2708``0xM`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
Richard Sandifordae426b42013-05-03 14:32:27 +00002709represented by ``0xL`` followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
2710will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
2711The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by ``0xH``
2712followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
2713(sign bit at the left).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002714
Reid Kleckner9a16d082014-03-05 02:41:37 +00002715There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002716
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00002717.. _complexconstants:
2718
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002719Complex Constants
2720-----------------
2721
2722Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple
2723constants and smaller complex constants.
2724
2725**Structure constants**
2726 Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
2727 structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
2728 surrounded by braces (``{}``)). For example:
2729 "``{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }``", where "``@G``" is declared as
2730 "``@G = external global i32``". Structure constants must have
2731 :ref:`structure type <t_struct>`, and the number and types of elements
2732 must match those specified by the type.
2733**Array constants**
2734 Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
2735 definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2736 square brackets (``[]``)). For example:
2737 "``[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]``". Array constants must have
2738 :ref:`array type <t_array>`, and the number and types of elements must
Daniel Sandersf6051842014-09-11 12:02:59 +00002739 match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array
2740 constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using the ``c``
2741 prefix. For example: "``c"Hello World\0A\00"``".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002742**Vector constants**
2743 Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
2744 type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
2745 less-than/greater-than's (``<>``)). For example:
2746 "``< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >``". Vector constants
2747 must have :ref:`vector type <t_vector>`, and the number and types of
2748 elements must match those specified by the type.
2749**Zero initialization**
2750 The string '``zeroinitializer``' can be used to zero initialize a
2751 value to zero of *any* type, including scalar and
2752 :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` types. This is often used to avoid
2753 having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and
2754 is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers.
2755**Metadata node**
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00002756 A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
2757 "``!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}``". Metadata can reference constant values,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00002758 for example: "``!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}``".
2759 Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of
2760 the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002761 information such as debug info.
2762
2763Global Variable and Function Addresses
2764--------------------------------------
2765
2766The addresses of :ref:`global variables <globalvars>` and
2767:ref:`functions <functionstructure>` are always implicitly valid
2768(link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when
2769the :ref:`identifier for the global <identifiers>` is used and always have
2770:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM
2771file:
2772
2773.. code-block:: llvm
2774
2775 @X = global i32 17
2776 @Y = global i32 42
2777 @Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
2778
2779.. _undefvalues:
2780
2781Undefined Values
2782----------------
2783
2784The string '``undef``' can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
2785indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
2786bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than '``label``'
2787or '``void``') and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
2788
2789Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that
2790the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the
2791compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of
2792(potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
2793
2794.. code-block:: llvm
2795
2796 %A = add %X, undef
2797 %B = sub %X, undef
2798 %C = xor %X, undef
2799 Safe:
2800 %A = undef
2801 %B = undef
2802 %C = undef
2803
2804This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef
2805bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
2806
2807.. code-block:: llvm
2808
2809 %A = or %X, undef
2810 %B = and %X, undef
2811 Safe:
2812 %A = -1
2813 %B = 0
2814 Unsafe:
2815 %A = undef
2816 %B = undef
2817
2818These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
2819input. For example, if ``%X`` has a zero bit, then the output of the
2820'``and``' operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
2821the corresponding bit from the '``undef``' is. As such, it is unsafe to
2822optimize or assume that the result of the '``and``' is '``undef``'.
2823However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the '``undef``' could be
28240, and optimize the '``and``' to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
2825all the bits of the '``undef``' operand to the '``or``' could be set,
2826allowing the '``or``' to be folded to -1.
2827
2828.. code-block:: llvm
2829
2830 %A = select undef, %X, %Y
2831 %B = select undef, 42, %Y
2832 %C = select %X, %Y, undef
2833 Safe:
2834 %A = %X (or %Y)
2835 %B = 42 (or %Y)
2836 %C = %Y
2837 Unsafe:
2838 %A = undef
2839 %B = undef
2840 %C = undef
2841
2842This set of examples shows that undefined '``select``' (and conditional
2843branch) conditions can go *either way*, but they have to come from one
2844of the two operands. In the ``%A`` example, if ``%X`` and ``%Y`` were
2845both known to have a clear low bit, then ``%A`` would have to have a
2846cleared low bit. However, in the ``%C`` example, the optimizer is
2847allowed to assume that the '``undef``' operand could be the same as
2848``%Y``, allowing the whole '``select``' to be eliminated.
2849
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00002850.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002851
2852 %A = xor undef, undef
2853
2854 %B = undef
2855 %C = xor %B, %B
2856
2857 %D = undef
Jonathan Roelofsec81c0b2014-10-16 19:28:10 +00002858 %E = icmp slt %D, 4
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002859 %F = icmp gte %D, 4
2860
2861 Safe:
2862 %A = undef
2863 %B = undef
2864 %C = undef
2865 %D = undef
2866 %E = undef
2867 %F = undef
2868
2869This example points out that two '``undef``' operands are not
2870necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
2871C semantics) where they assume that "``X^X``" is always zero, even if
2872``X`` is undefined. This isn't true for a number of reasons, but the
2873short answer is that an '``undef``' "variable" can arbitrarily change
2874its value over its "live range". This is true because the variable
2875doesn't actually *have a live range*. Instead, the value is logically
2876read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
2877the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, ``%A`` and
2878``%C`` need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM "replace all
2879uses with" concept would not hold.
2880
2881.. code-block:: llvm
2882
2883 %A = fdiv undef, %X
2884 %B = fdiv %X, undef
2885 Safe:
2886 %A = undef
2887 b: unreachable
2888
2889These examples show the crucial difference between an *undefined value*
2890and *undefined behavior*. An undefined value (like '``undef``') is
2891allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the ``%A``
2892operation can be constant folded to '``undef``', because the '``undef``'
2893could be an SNaN, and ``fdiv`` is not (currently) defined on SNaN's.
2894However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
2895assumption: because the ``undef`` is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
2896we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
2897has *undefined behavior*, we are allowed to assume that the operation
2898does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
2899code after it. Because the undefined operation "can't happen", the
2900optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
2901
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00002902.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002903
2904 a: store undef -> %X
2905 b: store %X -> undef
2906 Safe:
2907 a: <deleted>
2908 b: unreachable
2909
2910These examples reiterate the ``fdiv`` example: a store *of* an undefined
2911value can be assumed to not have any effect; we can assume that the
2912value is overwritten with bits that happen to match what was already
2913there. However, a store *to* an undefined location could clobber
2914arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined behavior.
2915
2916.. _poisonvalues:
2917
2918Poison Values
2919-------------
2920
2921Poison values are similar to :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`, however
2922they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002923that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition
2924that results in undefined behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002925
2926There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
2927only exist when produced by operations such as :ref:`add <i_add>` with
2928the ``nsw`` flag.
2929
2930Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value *dependence*:
2931
2932- Values other than :ref:`phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on their operands.
2933- :ref:`Phi <i_phi>` nodes depend on the operand corresponding to
2934 their dynamic predecessor basic block.
2935- Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values
2936 in the dynamic callers of their functions.
2937- :ref:`Call <i_call>` instructions depend on the :ref:`ret <i_ret>`
2938 instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
2939- :ref:`Invoke <i_invoke>` instructions depend on the
2940 :ref:`ret <i_ret>`, :ref:`resume <i_resume>`, or exception-throwing
2941 call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
2942- Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all
2943 of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR
2944 (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as
2945 :ref:`@llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>`.)
2946- An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the
2947 most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side
2948 effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes :ref:`volatile
2949 operations <volatile>`.)
2950- An instruction *control-depends* on a :ref:`terminator
2951 instruction <terminators>` if the terminator instruction has
2952 multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when
2953 control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed
2954 when control is transferred to another.
2955- Additionally, an instruction also *control-depends* on a terminator
2956 instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would
2957 be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different
2958 successor.
2959- Dependence is transitive.
2960
Richard Smith32dbdf62014-07-31 04:25:36 +00002961Poison values have the same behavior as :ref:`undef values <undefvalues>`,
2962with the additional effect that any instruction that has a *dependence*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002963on a poison value has undefined behavior.
2964
2965Here are some examples:
2966
2967.. code-block:: llvm
2968
2969 entry:
2970 %poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
2971 %still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00002972 %poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002973 store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
2974
2975 store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00002976 %poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002977
2978 store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
2979
2980 %narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
2981 %wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00002982 %poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
2983 %poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00002984
2985 %cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
2986 br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
2987
2988 true:
2989 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
2990 ; it has undefined behavior.
2991 br label %end
2992
2993 end:
2994 %p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
2995 ; Both edges into this PHI are
2996 ; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
2997 ; always results in a poison value.
2998
2999 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
3000 ; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
3001 ; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
3002
3003 br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
3004 ; The same branch again, but this time the
3005 ; true block doesn't have side effects.
3006
3007 second_true:
3008 ; No side effects!
3009 ret void
3010
3011 second_end:
3012 store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
3013 ; on the store in %end. Also, it is
3014 ; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
3015 ; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
3016 ; behavior in this example).
3017
3018.. _blockaddress:
3019
3020Addresses of Basic Blocks
3021-------------------------
3022
3023``blockaddress(@function, %block)``
3024
3025The '``blockaddress``' constant computes the address of the specified
3026basic block in the specified function, and always has an ``i8*`` type.
3027Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
3028
3029This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
3030':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`' instruction, or for comparisons
3031against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00003032undefined behavior --- though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003033no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
3034opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
3035allows ``ptrtoint`` and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
3036long as the original value is reconstituted before the ``indirectbr``
3037instruction.
3038
3039Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value
3040as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
3041
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00003042.. _constantexprs:
3043
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003044Constant Expressions
3045--------------------
3046
3047Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other
3048constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any
3049:ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type and may involve any LLVM operation
3050that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported).
3051The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
3052
3053``trunc (CST to TYPE)``
3054 Truncate a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
3055 larger than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
3056``zext (CST to TYPE)``
3057 Zero extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
3058 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
3059``sext (CST to TYPE)``
3060 Sign extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be
3061 smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
3062``fptrunc (CST to TYPE)``
3063 Truncate a floating point constant to another floating point type.
3064 The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types
3065 must be floating point.
3066``fpext (CST to TYPE)``
3067 Floating point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST
3068 must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be
3069 floating point.
3070``fptoui (CST to TYPE)``
3071 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding unsigned
3072 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3073 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
3074 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3075 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
3076``fptosi (CST to TYPE)``
3077 Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding signed
3078 integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST
3079 must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE
3080 must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the
3081 value won't fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
3082``uitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3083 Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding floating
3084 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
3085 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3086 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
3087 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
3088``sitofp (CST to TYPE)``
3089 Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating
3090 point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type.
3091 CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must
3092 be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value
3093 won't fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
3094``ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)``
3095 Convert a pointer typed constant to the corresponding integer
Eli Bendersky9c0d4932013-03-11 16:51:15 +00003096 constant. ``TYPE`` must be an integer type. ``CST`` must be of
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003097 pointer type. The ``CST`` value is zero extended, truncated, or
3098 unchanged to make it fit in ``TYPE``.
3099``inttoptr (CST to TYPE)``
3100 Convert an integer constant to a pointer constant. TYPE must be a
3101 pointer type. CST must be of integer type. The CST value is zero
3102 extended, truncated, or unchanged to make it fit in a pointer size.
3103 This one is *really* dangerous!
3104``bitcast (CST to TYPE)``
3105 Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE. The constraints of the
3106 operands are the same as those for the :ref:`bitcast
3107 instruction <i_bitcast>`.
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00003108``addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)``
3109 Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another
3110 TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the
3111 same as those for the :ref:`addrspacecast instruction <i_addrspacecast>`.
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00003112``getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``, ``getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003113 Perform the :ref:`getelementptr operation <i_getelementptr>` on
3114 constants. As with the :ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`
3115 instruction, the index list may have zero or more indexes, which are
David Blaikief72d05b2015-03-13 18:20:45 +00003116 required to make sense for the type of "pointer to TY".
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003117``select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)``
3118 Perform the :ref:`select operation <i_select>` on constants.
3119``icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3120 Performs the :ref:`icmp operation <i_icmp>` on constants.
3121``fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)``
3122 Performs the :ref:`fcmp operation <i_fcmp>` on constants.
3123``extractelement (VAL, IDX)``
3124 Perform the :ref:`extractelement operation <i_extractelement>` on
3125 constants.
3126``insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)``
3127 Perform the :ref:`insertelement operation <i_insertelement>` on
3128 constants.
3129``shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)``
3130 Perform the :ref:`shufflevector operation <i_shufflevector>` on
3131 constants.
3132``extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3133 Perform the :ref:`extractvalue operation <i_extractvalue>` on
3134 constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as
3135 indices in a ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At
3136 least one index value must be specified.
3137``insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)``
3138 Perform the :ref:`insertvalue operation <i_insertvalue>` on constants.
3139 The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a
3140 ':ref:`getelementptr <i_getelementptr>`' operation. At least one index
3141 value must be specified.
3142``OPCODE (LHS, RHS)``
3143 Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE
3144 may be any of the :ref:`binary <binaryops>` or :ref:`bitwise
3145 binary <bitwiseops>` operations. The constraints on operands are
3146 the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise
3147 operations on floating point values are allowed).
3148
3149Other Values
3150============
3151
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00003152.. _inlineasmexprs:
3153
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003154Inline Assembler Expressions
3155----------------------------
3156
3157LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to :ref:`Module-Level
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003158Inline Assembly <moduleasm>`) through the use of a special value. This value
3159represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the
3160instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a
3161flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects,
3162and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its
3163stack conservatively.
3164
3165The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using "``$``"
3166followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
3167location, as specified by the constraint string. "``${NUM:MODIFIER}``" may also
3168be used, where ``MODIFIER`` is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
3169operand (See :ref:`inline-asm-modifiers`).
3170
3171A literal "``$``" may be included by using "``$$``" in the template. To include
3172other special characters into the output, the usual "``\XX``" escapes may be
3173used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
3174resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM's integrated assembler unless it is
3175disabled -- even when emitting a ``.s`` file -- and thus must contain assembly
3176syntax known to LLVM.
3177
3178LLVM's support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang's
3179GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and
3180modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC's inline asm
3181support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings
3182described here is *not* the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and,
3183while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get
3184translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM
3185assembly.
3186
3187An example inline assembler expression is:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003188
3189.. code-block:: llvm
3190
3191 i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
3192
3193Inline assembler expressions may **only** be used as the callee operand
3194of a :ref:`call <i_call>` or an :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>` instruction.
3195Thus, typically we have:
3196
3197.. code-block:: llvm
3198
3199 %X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
3200
3201Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
3202marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
3203'``sideeffect``' keyword, like so:
3204
3205.. code-block:: llvm
3206
3207 call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
3208
3209In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
3210the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
3211x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
3212The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
3213might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
3214prologue if the '``alignstack``' keyword is present:
3215
3216.. code-block:: llvm
3217
3218 call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
3219
3220Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
3221assumed dialect is ATT. When the '``inteldialect``' keyword is present,
3222the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
3223the only supported dialects. An example is:
3224
3225.. code-block:: llvm
3226
3227 call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
3228
3229If multiple keywords appear the '``sideeffect``' keyword must come
3230first, the '``alignstack``' keyword second and the '``inteldialect``'
3231keyword last.
3232
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003233Inline Asm Constraint String
3234^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3235
3236The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or
3237more constraint codes.
3238
3239For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
3240operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
3241string expansion as ``$0`` for the first constraint in the list, ``$1`` for the
3242second, etc.
3243
3244There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a
3245prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The
3246constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then
3247clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
3248
3249There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
3250
3251- Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical
3252 register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary,
3253 bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
3254- Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction
3255 taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing
3256 modes used by the target.
3257- Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other
3258 immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The
3259 various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the
3260 proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
3261
3262Output constraints
3263""""""""""""""""""
3264
3265Output constraints are specified by an "``=``" prefix (e.g. "``=r``"). This
3266indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
3267then be made available as a return value of the ``asm`` expression. Output
3268constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
3269below about indirect outputs).
3270
3271Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
3272expression until *all* of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
3273the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
3274assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
3275the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the "``&``"
3276modifier must be used (e.g. "``=&r``") to specify that the output is an
Sylvestre Ledru84666a12016-02-14 20:16:22 +00003277"early-clobber" output. Marking an output as "early-clobber" ensures that LLVM
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003278will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
3279output).
3280
3281Input constraints
3282"""""""""""""""""
3283
3284Input constraints do not have a prefix -- just the constraint codes. Each input
3285constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not
3286permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless
3287that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be
3288assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all
3289contain the same value.
3290
3291Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also "tie"
3292themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
3293string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
3294take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual -- they will simply
3295be constrained to always use the same register as the output they've been tied
3296to. For example, a constraint string of "``=r,0``" says to assign a register for
3297output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0'th
3298constraint).
3299
3300It is permitted to tie an input to an "early-clobber" output. In that case, no
3301*other* input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber
3302(even when the other input has the same value).
3303
3304You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a
3305memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
3306
3307There is also an "interesting" feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a
3308register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value
3309type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple
3310registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
3311
3312However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
3313
3314Firstly, the registers are *not* guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those
3315architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive
3316instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit
3317SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The
3318hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This
3319feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
3320
3321A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
3322to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS ``L``, ``M``, and
3323``D``). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
3324register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you're still
3325probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
3326clarity. (e.g. see the description of the ``A`` constraint on X86, which,
3327despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
3328use)
3329
3330Indirect inputs and outputs
3331"""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3332
3333Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the "``*``" modifier
3334(which goes after the "``=``" in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
3335will write to or read from the contents of an *address* provided as an input
3336argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an *input* than
3337an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
3338rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
3339"output" only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
3340memory location, instead of just read from it).
3341
3342This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. "``=*m``", to pass the
3343address of a variable as a value.
3344
3345It is also possible to use an indirect *register* constraint, but only on output
3346(e.g. "``=*r``"). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
3347value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
3348input, after the provided inline asm. (It's not clear what value this
3349functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
3350statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
3351optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
3352
3353
3354Clobber constraints
3355"""""""""""""""""""
3356
3357A clobber constraint is indicated by a "``~``" prefix. A clobber does not
3358consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
3359general constraint code letters -- they may use only explicit register
3360constraints, e.g. "``~{eax}``". The one exception is that a clobber string of
3361"``~{memory}``" indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
3362memory locations -- not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
3363output.
3364
3365
3366Constraint Codes
3367""""""""""""""""
3368After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
3369
3370A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. "``r``"), a "``^``" character
3371followed by two letters (e.g. "``^wc``"), or "``{``" register-name "``}``"
3372(e.g. "``{eax}``").
3373
3374The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as
3375GCC's constraint codes.
3376
3377A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving
3378it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for
3379compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
3380
3381There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an
3382inline asm constraint list:
3383
33841) Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. "``im``"
3385 or "``{eax}m``". This means "choose any of the options in the set". The
3386 choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the
3387 constraint list.
3388
33892) Use "``|``" between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every
3390 constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative
3391 sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in *all* of the items in the
3392 constraint list will be chosen together.
3393
3394Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
3395``"rm|r,ri|rm"``. This indicates that if operand 0 is ``r`` or ``m``, then
3396operand 1 may be one of ``r`` or ``i``. If operand 0 is ``r``, then operand 1
3397may be one of ``r`` or ``m``. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
3398
3399However, the use of either of the alternatives features is *NOT* recommended, as
3400LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
3401point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
3402in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that's most likely to
3403compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given "``rm``", it'll
3404always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
3405or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
3406doesn't currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
3407unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
3408``{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}``, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
3409intended.)
3410
3411Supported Constraint Code List
3412""""""""""""""""""""""""""""""
3413
3414The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3415GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3416inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3417and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3418
3419Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
3420
3421- ``r``: A register in the target's general purpose register class.
3422- ``m``: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes
3423 are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset,
3424 or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).
3425- ``i``: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple
3426 immediate, or a relocatable value.
3427- ``n``: An integer constant -- *not* including relocatable values.
3428- ``s``: An integer constant, but allowing *only* relocatable values.
3429- ``X``: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically
3430 useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.
3431
3432 .. FIXME: but that surely isn't actually okay to jump out of an asm
3433 block without telling llvm about the control transfer???)
3434
3435- ``{register-name}``: Requires exactly the named physical register.
3436
3437Other constraints are target-specific:
3438
3439AArch64:
3440
3441- ``z``: An immediate integer 0. Outputs ``WZR`` or ``XZR``, as appropriate.
3442- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for an ``ADD`` or ``SUB`` instruction,
3443 i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.
3444- ``J``: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for an ``ADD`` or
3445 ``SUB`` instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.
3446- ``K``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 32' of a
3447 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 32-bit register.
3448- ``L``: An immediate integer that is valid for the 'bitmask immediate 64' of a
3449 logical instruction like ``AND``, ``EOR``, or ``ORR`` with a 64-bit register.
3450- ``M``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3451 32-bit register. This is a superset of ``K``: in addition to the bitmask
3452 immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a single
3453 ``MOVZ`` or ``MOVL`` instruction.
3454- ``N``: An immediate integer for use with the ``MOV`` assembly alias on a
3455 64-bit register. This is a superset of ``L``.
3456- ``Q``: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no
3457 offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for the ``m`` constraint as
3458 well.)
3459- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).
3460- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.
3461- ``x``: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (``V0`` to ``V15``).
3462
3463AMDGPU:
3464
3465- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3466- ``[0-9]v``: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.
3467- ``[0-9]s``: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
3468
3469
3470All ARM modes:
3471
3472- ``Q``, ``Um``, ``Un``, ``Uq``, ``Us``, ``Ut``, ``Uv``, ``Uy``: Memory address
3473 operand. Treated the same as operand ``m``, at the moment.
3474
3475ARM and ARM's Thumb2 mode:
3476
3477- ``j``: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid for ``MOVW``)
3478- ``I``: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.
3479- ``J``: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.
3480- ``K``: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a
3481 data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``B``" to
3482 print the inverted value).
3483- ``L``: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing
3484 instruction. (Can be used with template modifier "``n``" to print the negated
3485 value).
3486- ``M``: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.
3487- ``N``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3488- ``O``: Invalid immediate constraint.
3489- ``r``: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (``r0-r15``).
3490- ``l``: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (``r0-r7``). In ARM mode, same
3491 as ``r``.
3492- ``h``: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (``r8-r15``). In ARM mode,
3493 invalid.
3494- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3495 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3496- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3497 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3498- ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
3499 ``s0-s31``.
3500
3501ARM's Thumb1 mode:
3502
3503- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.
3504- ``J``: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.
3505- ``K``: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by
3506 some amount.
3507- ``L``: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.
3508- ``M``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.
3509- ``N``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3510- ``O``: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.
3511- ``r``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3512- ``l``: A low 32-bit GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3513- ``h``: A high GPR register (``r0-r7``).
3514- ``w``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s31``,
3515 ``d0-d31``, or ``q0-q15``.
3516- ``x``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register: ``s0-s15``,
3517 ``d0-d7``, or ``q0-q3``.
3518- ``t``: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:
3519 ``s0-s31``.
3520
3521
3522Hexagon:
3523
3524- ``o``, ``v``: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraint ``m``,
3525 at the moment.
3526- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit register.
3527
3528MSP430:
3529
3530- ``r``: An 8 or 16-bit register.
3531
3532MIPS:
3533
3534- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3535- ``J``: An immediate integer zero.
3536- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3537- ``L``: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.
3538- ``N``: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.
3539- ``O``: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.
3540- ``P``: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.
3541- ``m``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3542 register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.
3543- ``R``: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address
3544 register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraint
3545 ``m``.
3546- ``ZC``: A memory address operand, suitable for use in a ``pref``, ``ll``, or
3547 ``sc`` instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).
3548- ``r``, ``d``, ``y``: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.
3549- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (``F0-F31``), or a 128-bit MSA register
Daniel Sanders3745e022015-07-13 09:24:21 +00003550 (``W0-W31``). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use the ``w``
3551 argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003552- ``c``: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always
3553 ``25``).
3554- ``l``: The ``lo`` register, 32 or 64-bit.
3555- ``x``: Invalid.
3556
3557NVPTX:
3558
3559- ``b``: A 1-bit integer register.
3560- ``c`` or ``h``: A 16-bit integer register.
3561- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3562- ``l`` or ``N``: A 64-bit integer register.
3563- ``f``: A 32-bit float register.
3564- ``d``: A 64-bit float register.
3565
3566
3567PowerPC:
3568
3569- ``I``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3570- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3571- ``K``: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.
3572- ``L``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.
3573- ``M``: An immediate integer greater than 31.
3574- ``N``: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.
3575- ``O``: The immediate integer constant 0.
3576- ``P``: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit
3577 constant.
3578- ``es``, ``o``, ``Q``, ``Z``, ``Zy``: A memory address operand, currently
3579 treated the same as ``m``.
3580- ``r``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.
3581- ``b``: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excluding ``R0`` (that is:
3582 ``R1-R31``).
3583- ``f``: A 32 or 64-bit float register (``F0-F31``), or when QPX is enabled, a
3584 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``; aliases the ``F`` registers).
3585- ``v``: For ``4 x f32`` or ``4 x f64`` types, when QPX is enabled, a
3586 128 or 256-bit QPX register (``Q0-Q31``), otherwise a 128-bit
3587 altivec vector register (``V0-V31``).
3588
3589 .. FIXME: is this a bug that v accepts QPX registers? I think this
3590 is supposed to only use the altivec vector registers?
3591
3592- ``y``: Condition register (``CR0-CR7``).
3593- ``wc``: An individual CR bit in a CR register.
3594- ``wa``, ``wd``, ``wf``: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX
3595 register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).
3596- ``ws``: A 32 or 64-bit floating point register, from the full VSX register
3597 set.
3598
3599Sparc:
3600
3601- ``I``: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.
3602- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3603
3604SystemZ:
3605
3606- ``I``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3607- ``J``: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.
3608- ``K``: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.
3609- ``L``: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.
3610- ``M``: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.
Ulrich Weiganddaae87aa2016-06-13 14:24:05 +00003611- ``Q``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 12-bit immediate
3612 unsigned displacement.
3613- ``R``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 12-bit immediate
3614 unsigned displacement, and an index register.
3615- ``S``: A memory address operand with a base address and a 20-bit immediate
3616 signed displacement.
3617- ``T``: A memory address operand with a base address, a 20-bit immediate
3618 signed displacement, and an index register.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003619- ``r`` or ``d``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.
3620- ``a``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an
3621 address context evaluates as zero).
3622- ``h``: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register
3623 (LLVM-specific)
3624- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating point register.
3625
3626X86:
3627
3628- ``I``: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.
3629- ``J``: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.
3630- ``K``: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.
3631- ``L``: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only)
3632 0xffffffff.
3633- ``M``: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.
3634- ``N``: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.
3635- ``O``: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.
3636- ``e``: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.
3637- ``Z``: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.
3638- ``o``, ``v``: Treated the same as ``m``, at the moment.
3639- ``q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3640 ``l`` integer register. On X86-32, this is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d``
3641 registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.
3642- ``Q``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bit
3643 ``h`` integer register. This is the ``a``, ``b``, ``c``, and ``d`` registers.
3644- ``r`` or ``l``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.
3645- ``R``: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit "legacy" integer register -- one which has
3646 existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.
3647- ``f``: A 32, 64, or 80-bit '387 FPU stack pseudo-register.
3648- ``y``: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.
3649- ``x``: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector
3650 operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit
3651 vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a
3652 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.
3653- ``Y``: The same as ``x``, if *SSE2* is enabled, otherwise an error.
3654- ``A``: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in
3655 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It
3656 is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit
3657 operand will get allocated only to RAX -- if two 32-bit operands are needed,
3658 you're better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm
3659 statement.
3660
3661XCore:
3662
3663- ``r``: A 32-bit integer register.
3664
3665
3666.. _inline-asm-modifiers:
3667
3668Asm template argument modifiers
3669^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3670
3671In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
3672"``${0:n}``".
3673
3674The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in
3675GCC. LLVM's support is often implemented on an 'as-needed' basis, to support C
3676inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM
3677and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
3678
3679Target-independent:
3680
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003681- ``c``: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003682 the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3683- ``n``: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the
3684 target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3685- ``l``: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label
3686 punctuation (e.g. no ``$`` prefix).
3687
3688AArch64:
3689
3690- ``w``: Print a GPR register with a ``w*`` name instead of ``x*`` name. E.g.,
3691 instead of ``x30``, print ``w30``.
3692- ``x``: Print a GPR register with a ``x*`` name. (this is the default, anyhow).
3693- ``b``, ``h``, ``s``, ``d``, ``q``: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with a
3694 ``b*``, ``h*``, ``s*``, ``d*``, or ``q*`` name, rather than the default of
3695 ``v*``.
3696
3697AMDGPU:
3698
3699- ``r``: No effect.
3700
3701ARM:
3702
3703- ``a``: Print an operand as an address (with ``[`` and ``]`` surrounding a
3704 register).
3705- ``P``: No effect.
3706- ``q``: No effect.
3707- ``y``: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print
3708 as ``d4[1]`` instead of ``s9``)
3709- ``B``: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without ``#``
3710 prefix.
3711- ``L``: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.
3712- ``M``: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints *all*
3713 register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.
3714- ``Q``: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order
3715 register of a two-register operand.
3716- ``R``: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order
3717 register of a two-register operand.
3718- ``H``: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,
3719 ``H`` is equivalent to ``Q``, and on little-endian system, ``H`` is equivalent
3720 to ``R``.)
3721
3722 .. FIXME: H doesn't currently support printing the second register
3723 of a two-register operand.
3724
3725- ``e``: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3726- ``f``: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.
3727- ``m``: Print the base register of a memory operand without the ``[`` and ``]``
3728 adornment.
3729
3730Hexagon:
3731
3732- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3733 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3734
3735 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3736 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
3737
3738- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
3739 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
3740
3741MSP430:
3742
3743No additional modifiers.
3744
3745MIPS:
3746
3747- ``X``: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimal
3748- ``x``: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.
3749- ``d``: Print an immediate integer as decimal.
3750- ``m``: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.
3751- ``z``: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.
3752- ``L``: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3753 address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3754
3755 .. FIXME: L seems to be missing memory operand support.
3756
3757- ``M``: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3758 address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.
3759
3760 .. FIXME: M seems to be missing memory operand support.
3761
3762- ``D``: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the
3763 second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system, ``D`` is
3764 equivalent to ``L``, and on little-endian system, ``D`` is equivalent to
3765 ``M``.)
Daniel Sanders3745e022015-07-13 09:24:21 +00003766- ``w``: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this
3767 modifier in order to print MSA registers (``W0-W31``) with the ``f``
3768 constraint.
James Y Knightbc832ed2015-07-08 18:08:36 +00003769
3770NVPTX:
3771
3772- ``r``: No effect.
3773
3774PowerPC:
3775
3776- ``L``: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it
3777 has been allocated consecutively to the first.
3778
3779 .. FIXME: why is it restricted to consecutive ones? And there's
3780 nothing that ensures that happens, is there?
3781
3782- ``I``: Print the letter 'i' if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise
3783 nothing. Used to print 'addi' vs 'add' instructions.
3784- ``y``: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form
3785 instruction. (Currently always prints ``r0,OPERAND``).
3786- ``U``: Prints 'u' if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing
3787 otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently
3788 always print nothing)
3789- ``X``: Prints 'x' if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does
3790 not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
3791
3792Sparc:
3793
3794- ``r``: No effect.
3795
3796SystemZ:
3797
3798SystemZ implements only ``n``, and does *not* support any of the other
3799target-independent modifiers.
3800
3801X86:
3802
3803- ``c``: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is
3804 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).
3805- ``A``: Print a register name with a '``*``' before it.
3806- ``b``: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g. ``al``); do nothing on a memory
3807 operand.
3808- ``h``: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g. ``ah``); do nothing on a
3809 memory operand.
3810- ``w``: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g. ``ax``); do nothing on a memory
3811 operand.
3812- ``k``: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g. ``eax``); do nothing on a memory
3813 operand.
3814- ``q``: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g. ``rax``), if 64-bit registers are
3815 available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.
3816- ``n``: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an
3817 immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a '-' before
3818 the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a
3819 target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)
3820- ``H``: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.
3821- ``P``: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call
3822 instruction. (E.g. omit ``(rip)``, even though it's PC-relative.)
3823
3824XCore:
3825
3826No additional modifiers.
3827
3828
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003829Inline Asm Metadata
3830^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3831
3832The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
3833"``!srcloc``" MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
3834integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
3835location cookie value when report errors through the ``LLVMContext``
3836error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
3837errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
3838it. For example:
3839
3840.. code-block:: llvm
3841
3842 call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
3843 ...
3844 !42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
3845
3846It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places
3847in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator
3848will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error
3849occurs on.
3850
3851.. _metadata:
3852
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003853Metadata
3854========
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003855
3856LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program
3857that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and
3858code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level
3859debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003860
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003861Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003862``call`` instruction, it uses the ``metadata`` type.
3863
3864All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point ('``!``').
3865
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003866.. _metadata-string:
3867
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003868Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
3869-----------------------------------
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003870
3871A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
3872contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
3873"``\xx``" where "``xx``" is the two digit hex code. For example:
3874"``!"test\00"``".
3875
3876Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure
3877constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and
3878preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as
3879their operand. For example:
3880
3881.. code-block:: llvm
3882
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003883 !{ !"test\00", i32 10}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003884
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith090a19b2015-01-08 22:38:29 +00003885Metadata nodes that aren't uniqued use the ``distinct`` keyword. For example:
3886
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00003887.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith090a19b2015-01-08 22:38:29 +00003888
3889 !0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
3890
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith99010342015-01-08 23:50:26 +00003891``distinct`` nodes are useful when nodes shouldn't be merged based on their
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003892content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith99010342015-01-08 23:50:26 +00003893when metadata operands change.
3894
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003895A :ref:`named metadata <namedmetadatastructure>` is a collection of
3896metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For
3897example:
3898
3899.. code-block:: llvm
3900
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00003901 !foo = !{!4, !3}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003902
3903Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here ``llvm.dbg.value``
3904function is using two metadata arguments:
3905
3906.. code-block:: llvm
3907
3908 call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, i64 0, metadata !25)
3909
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00003910Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata ``!21`` is attached
3911to the ``add`` instruction using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003912
3913.. code-block:: llvm
3914
3915 %indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
3916
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00003917Metadata can also be attached to a function definition. Here metadata ``!22``
3918is attached to the ``foo`` function using the ``!dbg`` identifier:
3919
3920.. code-block:: llvm
3921
3922 define void @foo() !dbg !22 {
3923 ret void
3924 }
3925
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00003926More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the
3927optimizers and code generator is found below.
3928
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003929.. _specialized-metadata:
3930
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003931Specialized Metadata Nodes
3932^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
3933
3934Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003935to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00003936order.
3937
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003938These aren't inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized
3939metadata nodes are related to debug info.
3940
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003941.. _DICompileUnit:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003942
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003943DICompileUnit
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003944"""""""""""""
3945
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003946``DICompileUnit`` nodes represent a compile unit. The ``enums:``,
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00003947``retainedTypes:``, ``subprograms:``, ``globals:``, ``imports:`` and ``macros:``
3948fields are tuples containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile
3949unit, regardless of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003950references to them from instructions).
3951
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00003952.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003953
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003954 !0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003955 isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
Adrian Prantlb8089512016-04-01 00:16:49 +00003956 splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: FullDebug,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003957 enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, subprograms: !4,
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00003958 globals: !5, imports: !6, macros: !7, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003959
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003960Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003961specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope.
3962These descriptors are collected by a named metadata ``!llvm.dbg.cu``. They
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003963keep track of subprograms, global variables, type information, and imported
3964entities (declarations and namespaces).
3965
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003966.. _DIFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003967
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003968DIFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003969""""""
3970
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003971``DIFile`` nodes represent files. The ``filename:`` can include slashes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003972
3973.. code-block:: llvm
3974
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003975 !0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003976
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003977Files are sometimes used in ``scope:`` fields, and are the only valid target
3978for ``file:`` fields.
3979
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00003980.. _DIBasicType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003981
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003982DIBasicType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003983"""""""""""
3984
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003985``DIBasicType`` nodes represent primitive types, such as ``int``, ``bool`` and
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003986``float``. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_base_type``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003987
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00003988.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003989
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003990 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003991 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00003992 !1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00003993
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00003994The ``encoding:`` describes the details of the type. Usually it's one of the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003995following:
3996
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00003997.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00003998
3999 DW_ATE_address = 1
4000 DW_ATE_boolean = 2
4001 DW_ATE_float = 4
4002 DW_ATE_signed = 5
4003 DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
4004 DW_ATE_unsigned = 7
4005 DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
4006
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004007.. _DISubroutineType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004008
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004009DISubroutineType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004010""""""""""""""""
4011
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004012``DISubroutineType`` nodes represent subroutine types. Their ``types:`` field
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004013refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004014types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is ``null``, that
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004015represents a function with no return value (such as ``void foo() {}`` in C++).
4016
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004017.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004018
4019 !0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
4020 !1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004021 !2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004022
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004023.. _DIDerivedType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004024
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004025DIDerivedType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004026"""""""""""""
4027
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004028``DIDerivedType`` nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004029qualified types.
4030
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004031.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004032
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004033 !0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004034 encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004035 !1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004036 align: 32)
4037
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004038The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4039
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004040.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004041
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004042 DW_TAG_member = 13
4043 DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
4044 DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
4045 DW_TAG_typedef = 22
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004046 DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004047 DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
4048 DW_TAG_const_type = 38
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004049 DW_TAG_friend = 42
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004050 DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
4051 DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
4052
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004053.. _DIDerivedTypeMember:
4054
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004055``DW_TAG_member`` is used to define a member of a :ref:`composite type
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith90990cd2016-04-17 00:45:00 +00004056<DICompositeType>`. The type of the member is the ``baseType:``. The
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004057``offset:`` is the member's bit offset. If the composite type has an ODR
4058``identifier:`` and does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``, then the member is
4059uniqued based only on its ``name:`` and ``scope:``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004060
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004061``DW_TAG_inheritance`` and ``DW_TAG_friend`` are used in the ``elements:``
4062field of :ref:`composite types <DICompositeType>` to describe parents and
4063friends.
4064
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004065``DW_TAG_typedef`` is used to provide a name for the ``baseType:``.
4066
4067``DW_TAG_pointer_type``, ``DW_TAG_reference_type``, ``DW_TAG_const_type``,
4068``DW_TAG_volatile_type`` and ``DW_TAG_restrict_type`` are used to qualify the
4069``baseType:``.
4070
4071Note that the ``void *`` type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
4072
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004073.. _DICompositeType:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004074
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004075DICompositeType
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004076"""""""""""""""
4077
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004078``DICompositeType`` nodes represent types composed of other types, like
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004079structures and unions. ``elements:`` points to a tuple of the composed types.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004080
4081If the source language supports ODR, the ``identifier:`` field gives the unique
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004082identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified,
4083:ref:`subprogram declarations <DISubprogramDeclaration>` and :ref:`member
4084derived types <DIDerivedTypeMember>` that reference the ODR-type in their
4085``scope:`` change uniquing rules.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004086
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith5ab2be02016-04-17 03:58:21 +00004087For a given ``identifier:``, there should only be a single composite type that
4088does not have ``flags: DIFlagFwdDecl`` set. LLVM tools that link modules
4089together will unique such definitions at parse time via the ``identifier:``
4090field, even if the nodes are ``distinct``.
4091
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004092.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004093
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004094 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4095 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4096 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
4097 !3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004098 line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
4099 elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
4100
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004101The following ``tag:`` values are valid:
4102
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004103.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004104
4105 DW_TAG_array_type = 1
4106 DW_TAG_class_type = 2
4107 DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
4108 DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
4109 DW_TAG_union_type = 23
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004110
4111For ``DW_TAG_array_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`subrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004112descriptors <DISubrange>`, each representing the range of subscripts at that
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004113level of indexing. The ``DIFlagVector`` flag to ``flags:`` indicates that an
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004114array type is a native packed vector.
4115
4116For ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`enumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004117descriptors <DIEnumerator>`, each representing the definition of an enumeration
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004118value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004119``enums:`` field of the :ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004120
4121For ``DW_TAG_structure_type``, ``DW_TAG_class_type``, and
4122``DW_TAG_union_type``, the ``elements:`` should be :ref:`derived types
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha3f3de12016-04-16 22:46:47 +00004123<DIDerivedType>` with ``tag: DW_TAG_member``, ``tag: DW_TAG_inheritance``, or
4124``tag: DW_TAG_friend``; or :ref:`subprograms <DISubprogram>` with
4125``isDefinition: false``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004126
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004127.. _DISubrange:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004128
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004129DISubrange
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004130""""""""""
4131
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004132``DISubrange`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_array_type`` variants of
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004133:ref:`DICompositeType`. ``count: -1`` indicates an empty array.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004134
4135.. code-block:: llvm
4136
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004137 !0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
4138 !1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
4139 !2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004140
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004141.. _DIEnumerator:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004142
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004143DIEnumerator
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004144""""""""""""
4145
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004146``DIEnumerator`` nodes are the elements for ``DW_TAG_enumeration_type``
4147variants of :ref:`DICompositeType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004148
4149.. code-block:: llvm
4150
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004151 !0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
4152 !1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
4153 !2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004154
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004155DITemplateTypeParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004156"""""""""""""""""""""""
4157
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004158``DITemplateTypeParameter`` nodes represent type parameters to generic source
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004159language constructs. They are used (optionally) in :ref:`DICompositeType` and
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004160:ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004161
4162.. code-block:: llvm
4163
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004164 !0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004165
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004166DITemplateValueParameter
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004167""""""""""""""""""""""""
4168
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004169``DITemplateValueParameter`` nodes represent value parameters to generic source
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004170language constructs. ``tag:`` defaults to ``DW_TAG_template_value_parameter``,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004171but if specified can also be set to ``DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param`` or
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004172``DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack``. They are used (optionally) in
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004173:ref:`DICompositeType` and :ref:`DISubprogram` ``templateParams:`` fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004174
4175.. code-block:: llvm
4176
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004177 !0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004178
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004179DINamespace
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004180"""""""""""
4181
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004182``DINamespace`` nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004183
4184.. code-block:: llvm
4185
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004186 !0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004187
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004188DIGlobalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004189""""""""""""""""
4190
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004191``DIGlobalVariable`` nodes represent global variables in the source language.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004192
4193.. code-block:: llvm
4194
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004195 !0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004196 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
4197 isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo,
4198 declaration: !4)
4199
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004200All global variables should be referenced by the `globals:` field of a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004201:ref:`compile unit <DICompileUnit>`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004202
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004203.. _DISubprogram:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004204
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004205DISubprogram
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004206""""""""""""
4207
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004208``DISubprogram`` nodes represent functions from the source language. A
4209``DISubprogram`` may be attached to a function definition using ``!dbg``
4210metadata. The ``variables:`` field points at :ref:`variables <DILocalVariable>`
4211that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
4212the IR. The ``type:`` field must point at an :ref:`DISubroutineType`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004213
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004214.. _DISubprogramDeclaration:
4215
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith05ebfd02016-04-17 02:30:20 +00004216When ``isDefinition: false``, subprograms describe a declaration in the type
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha59d3e52016-04-23 21:08:00 +00004217tree as opposed to a definition of a function. If the scope is a composite
4218type with an ODR ``identifier:`` and that does not set ``flags: DIFwdDecl``,
4219then the subprogram declaration is uniqued based only on its ``linkageName:``
4220and ``scope:``.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith05ebfd02016-04-17 02:30:20 +00004221
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004222.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004223
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004224 define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
4225 ...
4226 }
4227
4228 !0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
4229 file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith05ebfd02016-04-17 02:30:20 +00004230 isDefinition: true, scopeLine: 8,
Peter Collingbourne50108682015-11-06 02:41:02 +00004231 containingType: !4,
4232 virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
4233 virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
4234 isOptimized: true, templateParams: !5,
4235 declaration: !6, variables: !7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004236
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004237.. _DILexicalBlock:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004238
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004239DILexicalBlock
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004240""""""""""""""
4241
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004242``DILexicalBlock`` nodes describe nested blocks within a :ref:`subprogram
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004243<DISubprogram>`. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004244two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for ``scope:``
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004245fields.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004246
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004247.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004248
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004249 !0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithd937cd92015-03-17 23:41:05 +00004250
4251Usually lexical blocks are ``distinct`` to prevent node merging based on
4252operands.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004253
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004254.. _DILexicalBlockFile:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004255
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004256DILexicalBlockFile
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004257""""""""""""""""""
4258
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004259``DILexicalBlockFile`` nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004260:ref:`lexical block <DILexicalBlock>`. The ``file:`` field can be changed to
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004261indicate textual inclusion, or the ``discriminator:`` field can be used to
4262discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
4263
4264.. code-block:: llvm
4265
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004266 !0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
4267 !1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
4268 !2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004269
Michael Kuperstein605308a2015-05-14 10:58:59 +00004270.. _DILocation:
4271
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004272DILocation
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004273""""""""""
4274
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004275``DILocation`` nodes represent source debug locations. The ``scope:`` field is
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004276mandatory, and points at an :ref:`DILexicalBlockFile`, an
4277:ref:`DILexicalBlock`, or an :ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004278
4279.. code-block:: llvm
4280
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004281 !0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith6a484832015-01-13 21:10:44 +00004282
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004283.. _DILocalVariable:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004284
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004285DILocalVariable
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004286"""""""""""""""
4287
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004288``DILocalVariable`` nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithed013cd2015-07-31 18:58:39 +00004289the ``arg:`` field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
4290parameter, and it will be included in the ``variables:`` field of its
4291:ref:`DISubprogram`.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004292
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004293.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004294
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithed013cd2015-07-31 18:58:39 +00004295 !0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
4296 type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
4297 !1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
4298 type: !3)
4299 !2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004300
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004301DIExpression
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004302""""""""""""
4303
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004304``DIExpression`` nodes represent DWARF expression sequences. They are used in
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004305:ref:`debug intrinsics<dbg_intrinsics>` (such as ``llvm.dbg.declare``) to
4306describe how the referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language
4307variable.
4308
4309The current supported vocabulary is limited:
4310
4311- ``DW_OP_deref`` dereferences the working expression.
4312- ``DW_OP_plus, 93`` adds ``93`` to the working expression.
4313- ``DW_OP_bit_piece, 16, 8`` specifies the offset and size (``16`` and ``8``
4314 here, respectively) of the variable piece from the working expression.
4315
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004316.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004317
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004318 !0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
4319 !1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus, 3)
4320 !2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
4321 !3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_plus, 3, DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004322
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004323DIObjCProperty
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004324""""""""""""""
4325
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004326``DIObjCProperty`` nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004327
4328.. code-block:: llvm
4329
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004330 !3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004331 getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
4332
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004333DIImportedEntity
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004334""""""""""""""""
4335
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004336``DIImportedEntity`` nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004337compile unit.
4338
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004339.. code-block:: text
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004340
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitha9308c42015-04-29 16:38:44 +00004341 !2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +00004342 entity: !1, line: 7)
4343
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004344DIMacro
4345"""""""
4346
4347``DIMacro`` nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
4348The ``name:`` field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
Sylvestre Ledru7d540502016-07-02 19:28:40 +00004349defining a function-like macro, and the ``value`` field is the token-string
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004350used to expand the macro identifier.
4351
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004352.. code-block:: text
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004353
4354 !2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
4355 value: "((x) + 1)")
4356 !3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
4357
4358DIMacroFile
4359"""""""""""
4360
4361``DIMacroFile`` nodes represent inclusion of source files.
4362The ``nodes:`` field is a list of ``DIMacro`` and ``DIMacroFile`` nodes that
4363appear in the included source file.
4364
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00004365.. code-block:: text
Amjad Abouda9bcf162015-12-10 12:56:35 +00004366
4367 !2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
4368 nodes: !3)
4369
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004370'``tbaa``' Metadata
4371^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4372
4373In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM's own type system is not
4374suitable for doing TBAA. Instead, metadata is added to the IR to
4375describe a type system of a higher level language. This can be used to
4376implement typical C/C++ TBAA, but it can also be used to implement
4377custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
4378
4379The current metadata format is very simple. TBAA metadata nodes have up
4380to three fields, e.g.:
4381
4382.. code-block:: llvm
4383
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004384 !0 = !{ !"an example type tree" }
4385 !1 = !{ !"int", !0 }
4386 !2 = !{ !"float", !0 }
4387 !3 = !{ !"const float", !2, i64 1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004388
4389The first field is an identity field. It can be any value, usually a
4390metadata string, which uniquely identifies the type. The most important
4391name in the tree is the name of the root node. Two trees with different
4392root node names are entirely disjoint, even if they have leaves with
4393common names.
4394
4395The second field identifies the type's parent node in the tree, or is
4396null or omitted for a root node. A type is considered to alias all of
4397its descendants and all of its ancestors in the tree. Also, a type is
4398considered to alias all types in other trees, so that bitcode produced
4399from multiple front-ends is handled conservatively.
4400
4401If the third field is present, it's an integer which if equal to 1
4402indicates that the type is "constant" (meaning
4403``pointsToConstantMemory`` should return true; see `other useful
4404AliasAnalysis methods <AliasAnalysis.html#OtherItfs>`_).
4405
4406'``tbaa.struct``' Metadata
4407^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4408
4409The :ref:`llvm.memcpy <int_memcpy>` is often used to implement
4410aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it
4411is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than
4412strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to
4413padding. Also, it doesn't contain any TBAA information about the fields
4414of the aggregate.
4415
4416``!tbaa.struct`` metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
4417memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
4418
4419The current metadata format is very simple. ``!tbaa.struct`` metadata
4420nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
4421For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
4422field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
4423its tbaa tag. e.g.:
4424
4425.. code-block:: llvm
4426
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004427 !4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004428
4429This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes
4430with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes
4431and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
4432
4433Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a
44344 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which
4435does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
4436
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004437'``noalias``' and '``alias.scope``' Metadata
Dan Liewbafdcba2014-07-28 13:33:51 +00004438^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004439
4440``noalias`` and ``alias.scope`` metadata provide the ability to specify generic
4441noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
4442instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
4443``noalias`` metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
4444collection of memory access instructions that carry ``alias.scope`` metadata.
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004445Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
Adam Nemet569a5b32016-04-27 00:52:48 +00004446a domain.
4447
4448When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004449of scopes with that domain in one instruction's ``alias.scope`` list is a
Arch D. Robison96cf7ab2015-02-24 20:11:49 +00004450subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004451instruction's ``noalias`` list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
4452alias.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004453
Adam Nemet569a5b32016-04-27 00:52:48 +00004454Because scopes in one domain don't affect scopes in other domains, separate
4455domains can be used to compose multiple independent noalias sets. This is
4456used for example during inlining. As the noalias function parameters are
4457turned into noalias scope metadata, a new domain is used every time the
4458function is inlined.
4459
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004460The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two
4461entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004462string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004463self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A
4464descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
4465
4466The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or
4467three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +00004468is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004469self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata
4470reference to the scope's domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may
4471optionally be provided as a third list entry.
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004472
4473For example,
4474
4475.. code-block:: llvm
4476
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004477 ; Two scope domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004478 !0 = !{!0}
4479 !1 = !{!1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004480
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004481 ; Some scopes in these domains:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004482 !2 = !{!2, !0}
4483 !3 = !{!3, !0}
4484 !4 = !{!4, !1}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004485
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004486 ; Some scope lists:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004487 !5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
4488 !6 = !{!4, !3, !2}
4489 !7 = !{!3}
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004490
4491 ; These two instructions don't alias:
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004492 %0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004493 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004494
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004495 ; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
4496 ; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004497 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004498 store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004499
Adam Nemet0a8416f2015-05-11 08:30:28 +00004500 ; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004501 ; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
4502 ; !alias.scope list):
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004503 %2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
Hal Finkel029cde62014-07-25 15:50:02 +00004504 store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
Hal Finkel94146652014-07-24 14:25:39 +00004505
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004506'``fpmath``' Metadata
4507^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4508
4509``fpmath`` metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating point
4510type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
4511result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
4512compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
4513it. ULP is defined as follows:
4514
4515 If ``x`` is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive
4516 floating-point numbers ``a`` and ``b``, without being equal to one
4517 of them, then ``ulp(x) = |b - a|``, otherwise ``ulp(x)`` is the
4518 distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers
4519 nearest ``x``. Moreover, ``ulp(NaN)`` is ``NaN``.
4520
Matt Arsenault82f41512016-06-27 19:43:15 +00004521The metadata node shall consist of a single positive float type number
4522representing the maximum relative error, for example:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004523
4524.. code-block:: llvm
4525
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004526 !0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004527
Philip Reamesf8bf9dd2015-02-27 23:14:50 +00004528.. _range-metadata:
4529
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004530'``range``' Metadata
4531^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4532
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004533``range`` metadata may be attached only to ``load``, ``call`` and ``invoke`` of
4534integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
4535returned by the called function at this call site is in. The ranges are
4536represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or the value
4537returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each consecutive
4538pair. Each pair has the following properties:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004539
4540- The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
4541- The pair ``a,b`` represents the range ``[a,b)``.
4542- Both ``a`` and ``b`` are constants.
4543- The range is allowed to wrap.
4544- The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
4545 ``a!=b``.
4546
4547In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and
4548they must be non-contiguous.
4549
4550Examples:
4551
4552.. code-block:: llvm
4553
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004554 %a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
4555 %b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
Jingyue Wu37fcb592014-06-19 16:50:16 +00004556 %c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
4557 %d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
4558 unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004559 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004560 !0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
4561 !1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
4562 !2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
4563 !3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004564
Sanjay Patela99ab1f2015-09-02 19:06:43 +00004565'``unpredictable``' Metadata
Sanjay Patel1f12b342015-09-02 19:35:31 +00004566^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Sanjay Patela99ab1f2015-09-02 19:06:43 +00004567
4568``unpredictable`` metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
4569instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
4570flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
4571optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
4572is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
4573or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
4574
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004575'``llvm.loop``'
4576^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4577
4578It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
4579loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
4580in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00004581guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004582specified with the name ``llvm.loop``.
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004583
4584The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to
Michael Liaoa7699082013-03-06 18:24:34 +00004585itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g.,
4586during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer
4587to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions.
4588The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00004589constructs:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004590
4591.. code-block:: llvm
Paul Redmondeaaed3b2013-02-21 17:20:45 +00004592
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004593 !0 = !{!0}
4594 !1 = !{!1}
Pekka Jaaskelainen119a2b62013-02-22 12:03:07 +00004595
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004596The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
4597per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
4598as user-defined metadata. For example the ``llvm.loop.unroll.count``
4599suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004600
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004601.. code-block:: llvm
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004602
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004603 br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
4604 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004605 !0 = !{!0, !1}
4606 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004607
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004608'``llvm.loop.vectorize``' and '``llvm.loop.interleave``'
4609^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004610
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004611Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.vectorize`` or ``llvm.loop.interleave`` are
4612used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004613vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
4614conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop identification metadata. The
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004615``llvm.loop.vectorize`` and ``llvm.loop.interleave`` metadata are only
4616optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004617it believes it is safe to do so. The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004618which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
4619in determining the safety of these transformations.
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004620
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004621'``llvm.loop.interleave.count``' Metadata
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004622^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4623
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004624This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
4625The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` and the
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004626second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
4627example:
4628
4629.. code-block:: llvm
4630
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004631 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004632
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004633Note that setting ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` to 1 disables interleaving
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004634multiple iterations of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.interleave.count`` is set to 0
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004635then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
4636
4637'``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable``' Metadata
Dan Liew9a1829d2014-07-22 14:59:38 +00004638^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +00004639
4640This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
4641first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.enable`` and the second operand
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004642is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
Mark Heffernan9d20e422014-07-21 23:11:03 +000046430 disables vectorization:
4644
4645.. code-block:: llvm
4646
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004647 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
4648 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004649
4650'``llvm.loop.vectorize.width``' Metadata
4651^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4652
4653This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
4654operand is the string ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` and the second
4655operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
4656
4657.. code-block:: llvm
4658
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004659 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004660
4661Note that setting ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` to 1 disables
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004662vectorization of the loop. If ``llvm.loop.vectorize.width`` is set to
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +000046630 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
4664determined automatically.
4665
4666'``llvm.loop.unroll``'
4667^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4668
4669Metadata prefixed with ``llvm.loop.unroll`` are loop unrolling
4670optimization hints such as the unroll factor. ``llvm.loop.unroll``
4671metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
4672identification metadata. The ``llvm.loop.unroll`` metadata are only
4673optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
4674optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
4675
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004676'``llvm.loop.unroll.count``' Metadata
4677^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4678
4679This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
4680first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.count`` and the second
4681operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
4682example:
4683
4684.. code-block:: llvm
4685
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004686 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
Mark Heffernan893752a2014-07-18 19:24:51 +00004687
4688If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop
4689will be partially unrolled.
4690
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004691'``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``' Metadata
4692^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4693
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004694This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004695which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.disable``. For example:
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004696
4697.. code-block:: llvm
4698
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004699 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004700
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004701'``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``' Metadata
Dan Liew868b0742015-03-11 13:34:49 +00004702^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004703
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004704This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004705operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable``. For example:
Kevin Qin715b01e2015-03-09 06:14:18 +00004706
4707.. code-block:: llvm
4708
4709 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
4710
Mark Heffernan89391542015-08-10 17:28:08 +00004711'``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``' Metadata
4712^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4713
4714This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
4715is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
4716at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
4717``llvm.loop.unroll.enable``. For example:
4718
4719.. code-block:: llvm
4720
4721 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
4722
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004723'``llvm.loop.unroll.full``' Metadata
4724^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4725
Mark Heffernan3e32a4e2015-06-30 22:48:51 +00004726This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
4727metadata has a single operand which is the string ``llvm.loop.unroll.full``.
Mark Heffernane6b4ba12014-07-23 17:31:37 +00004728For example:
4729
4730.. code-block:: llvm
4731
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004732 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004733
Ashutosh Nemadf6763a2016-02-06 07:47:48 +00004734'``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``' Metadata
Ashutosh Nema5f0e4722016-02-06 09:24:37 +00004735^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Ashutosh Nemadf6763a2016-02-06 07:47:48 +00004736
4737This metadata indicates that the loop should not be versioned for the purpose
4738of enabling loop-invariant code motion (LICM). The metadata has a single operand
4739which is the string ``llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable``. For example:
4740
4741.. code-block:: llvm
4742
4743 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable"}
4744
Adam Nemetd2fa4142016-04-27 05:28:18 +00004745'``llvm.loop.distribute.enable``' Metadata
Adam Nemet55dc0af2016-04-27 05:59:51 +00004746^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Adam Nemetd2fa4142016-04-27 05:28:18 +00004747
4748Loop distribution allows splitting a loop into multiple loops. Currently,
4749this is only performed if the entire loop cannot be vectorized due to unsafe
4750memory dependencies. The transformation will atempt to isolate the unsafe
4751dependencies into their own loop.
4752
4753This metadata can be used to selectively enable or disable distribution of the
4754loop. The first operand is the string ``llvm.loop.distribute.enable`` and the
4755second operand is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 distribution is
4756enabled. A value of 0 disables distribution:
4757
4758.. code-block:: llvm
4759
4760 !0 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 0}
4761 !1 = !{!"llvm.loop.distribute.enable", i1 1}
4762
4763This metadata should be used in conjunction with ``llvm.loop`` loop
4764identification metadata.
4765
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004766'``llvm.mem``'
4767^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4768
4769Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful
4770for optimizations are prefixed with ``llvm.mem``.
4771
4772'``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``' Metadata
4773^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4774
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004775The ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata refers to a loop identifier,
4776or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops.
4777The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that
4778no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted
Hal Finkel411d31a2016-04-26 02:00:36 +00004779with the same loop identifier. The metadata on memory reads also implies that
4780if conversion (i.e. speculative execution within a loop iteration) is safe.
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004781
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004782Precisely, given two instructions ``m1`` and ``m2`` that both have the
4783``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata, with ``L1`` and ``L2`` being the
4784set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop
4785carried dependence between ``m1`` and ``m2`` for loops in both ``L1`` and
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004786``L2``.
4787
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004788As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have
4789``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access`` metadata that refers to that loop, then the
4790loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel
4791loop.
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004792
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004793Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to
4794the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00004795memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00004796safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered
4797sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics
Pekka Jaaskelainen23b222cc2014-05-23 11:35:46 +00004798insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004799
4800Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004801both ``llvm.loop`` and ``llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access``
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004802metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata.
4803
4804.. code-block:: llvm
4805
4806 for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004807 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004808 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004809 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004810 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004811 ...
4812 br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004813
4814 for.end:
4815 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004816 !0 = !{!0}
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004817
4818It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the
4819memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of
4820the loop identifier metadata node directly:
4821
4822.. code-block:: llvm
4823
4824 outer.for.body:
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004825 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004826 %val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004827 ...
4828 br label %inner.for.body
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004829
4830 inner.for.body:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004831 ...
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00004832 %val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004833 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004834 store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004835 ...
4836 br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004837
4838 inner.for.end:
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004839 ...
Tobias Grosserfbe95dc2014-03-05 13:36:04 +00004840 store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
Paul Redmond5fdf8362013-05-28 20:00:34 +00004841 ...
4842 br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004843
4844 outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
4845 ...
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004846 !0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers
4847 !1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop
4848 !2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop
Pekka Jaaskelainen0d237252013-02-13 18:08:57 +00004849
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00004850'``invariant.group``' Metadata
4851^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4852
4853The ``invariant.group`` metadata may be attached to ``load``/``store`` instructions.
4854The existence of the ``invariant.group`` metadata on the instruction tells
4855the optimizer that every ``load`` and ``store`` to the same pointer operand
4856within the same invariant group can be assumed to load or store the same
4857value (but see the ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` intrinsic which affects
4858when two pointers are considered the same).
4859
4860Examples:
4861
4862.. code-block:: llvm
4863
4864 @unknownPtr = external global i8
4865 ...
4866 %ptr = alloca i8
4867 store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
4868 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
4869
4870 %a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
4871 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
4872 %b = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !1 ; Can't assume anything, because group changed
4873
4874 %newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
4875 %c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
4876
4877 %unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
4878 store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
4879
4880 call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
4881 %newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* %ptr)
4882 %d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through invariant.group.barrier to get value of %ptr
4883
4884 ...
4885 declare void @foo(i8*)
4886 declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
4887 declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8*)
4888
4889 !0 = !{!"magic ptr"}
4890 !1 = !{!"other ptr"}
4891
Peter Collingbournea333db82016-07-26 22:31:30 +00004892'``type``' Metadata
4893^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
4894
4895See :doc:`TypeMetadata`.
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00004896
4897
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004898Module Flags Metadata
4899=====================
4900
4901Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM's
4902subsystems. The LLVM IR isn't sufficient to transmit this information.
4903The ``llvm.module.flags`` named metadata exists in order to facilitate
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00004904this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs --- much like a
4905dictionary --- making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004906look it up.
4907
4908The ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
4909Each triplet has the following form:
4910
4911- The first element is a *behavior* flag, which specifies the behavior
4912 when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two
4913 (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are
4914 described below.
4915- The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004916 metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not
4917 including entries with the **Require** behavior).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004918- The third element is the value of the flag.
4919
4920When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004921``llvm.module.flags`` metadata is the union of the modules' flags. That is, for
4922each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
4923modules ``llvm.module.flags`` metadata table, and the value for that entry will
4924be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
4925is that entries with the *Require* behavior are always preserved.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004926
4927The following behaviors are supported:
4928
4929.. list-table::
4930 :header-rows: 1
4931 :widths: 10 90
4932
4933 * - Value
4934 - Behavior
4935
4936 * - 1
4937 - **Error**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004938 Emits an error if two values disagree, otherwise the resulting value
4939 is that of the operands.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004940
4941 * - 2
4942 - **Warning**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004943 Emits a warning if two values disagree. The result value will be the
4944 operand for the flag from the first module being linked.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004945
4946 * - 3
4947 - **Require**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004948 Adds a requirement that another module flag be present and have a
4949 specified value after linking is performed. The value must be a
4950 metadata pair, where the first element of the pair is the ID of the
4951 module flag to be restricted, and the second element of the pair is
4952 the value the module flag should be restricted to. This behavior can
4953 be used to restrict the allowable results (via triggering of an
4954 error) of linking IDs with the **Override** behavior.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004955
4956 * - 4
4957 - **Override**
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004958 Uses the specified value, regardless of the behavior or value of the
4959 other module. If both modules specify **Override**, but the values
4960 differ, an error will be emitted.
4961
Daniel Dunbard77d9fb2013-01-16 21:38:56 +00004962 * - 5
4963 - **Append**
4964 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata nodes.
4965
4966 * - 6
4967 - **AppendUnique**
4968 Appends the two values, which are required to be metadata
4969 nodes. However, duplicate entries in the second list are dropped
4970 during the append operation.
4971
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004972It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors,
4973except in the case of **Require** (which adds restrictions on another metadata
4974value) or **Override**.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004975
4976An example of module flags:
4977
4978.. code-block:: llvm
4979
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00004980 !0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
4981 !1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
4982 !2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
4983 !3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
4984 !{
4985 !"foo", i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004986 }
4987 }
4988 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
4989
4990- Metadata ``!0`` has the ID ``!"foo"`` and the value '1'. The behavior
4991 if two or more ``!"foo"`` flags are seen is to emit an error if their
4992 values are not equal.
4993
4994- Metadata ``!1`` has the ID ``!"bar"`` and the value '37'. The
4995 behavior if two or more ``!"bar"`` flags are seen is to use the value
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00004996 '37'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00004997
4998- Metadata ``!2`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value '42'. The
4999 behavior if two or more ``!"qux"`` flags are seen is to emit a
5000 warning if their values are not equal.
5001
5002- Metadata ``!3`` has the ID ``!"qux"`` and the value:
5003
5004 ::
5005
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005006 !{ !"foo", i32 1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005007
Daniel Dunbar25c4b572013-01-15 01:22:53 +00005008 The behavior is to emit an error if the ``llvm.module.flags`` does not
5009 contain a flag with the ID ``!"foo"`` that has the value '1' after linking is
5010 performed.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005011
5012Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata
5013----------------------------------------------------
5014
5015On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage
5016collection in a special section called "image info". The metadata
5017consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of
5018garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more
5019modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to
5020be merged rather than appended together.
5021
5022The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the
5023following key-value pairs:
5024
5025.. list-table::
5026 :header-rows: 1
5027 :widths: 30 70
5028
5029 * - Key
5030 - Value
5031
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005032 * - ``Objective-C Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005033 - **[Required]** --- The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005034
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005035 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Version``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005036 - **[Required]** --- The version of the image info section. Currently
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005037 always 0.
5038
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005039 * - ``Objective-C Image Info Section``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005040 - **[Required]** --- The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005041 ``"__OBJC, __image_info, regular"`` for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
5042 ``"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip"`` for
5043 Objective-C ABI version 2.
5044
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005045 * - ``Objective-C Garbage Collection``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005046 - **[Required]** --- Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005047 not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage
5048 collection supported.
5049
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005050 * - ``Objective-C GC Only``
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00005051 - **[Optional]** --- Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005052 If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
5053 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag have the value 2.
5054
5055Some important flag interactions:
5056
5057- If a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 is
5058 merged with a module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to
5059 2, then the resulting module has the
5060 ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` flag set to 0.
5061- A module with ``Objective-C Garbage Collection`` set to 0 cannot be
5062 merged with a module with ``Objective-C GC Only`` set to 6.
5063
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00005064Automatic Linker Flags Module Flags Metadata
5065--------------------------------------------
5066
5067Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object
5068files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which
5069allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have
5070these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
5071
5072These flags are encoded in the IR using metadata in the module flags section,
Daniel Dunbar1dc66ca2013-01-17 18:57:32 +00005073using the ``Linker Options`` key. The merge behavior for this flag is required
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00005074to be ``AppendUnique``, and the value for the key is expected to be a metadata
5075node which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
5076list of metadata strings defining linker options.
5077
5078For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
5079linker options, presumably to link against ``libz`` and the ``Cocoa``
5080framework::
5081
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005082 !0 = !{ i32 6, !"Linker Options",
5083 !{
5084 !{ !"-lz" },
5085 !{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
Daniel Dunbar252bedc2013-01-17 00:16:27 +00005086 !llvm.module.flags = !{ !0 }
5087
5088The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed
5089list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option
5090strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be
5091preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific
5092assembly writer or object file emitter.
5093
5094Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target's
5095linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or
5096object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
5097
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00005098C type width Module Flags Metadata
5099----------------------------------
5100
5101The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the
5102options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent
5103linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some
5104of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum
5105width.
5106
5107To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module
5108flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
5109
5110.. list-table::
5111 :header-rows: 1
5112 :widths: 30 70
5113
5114 * - Key
5115 - Value
5116
5117 * - short_wchar
5118 - * 0 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 4
5119 * 1 --- sizeof(wchar_t) == 2
5120
5121 * - short_enum
5122 - * 0 --- Enums are at least as large as an ``int``.
5123 * 1 --- Enums are stored in the smallest integer type which can
5124 represent all of its values.
5125
5126For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
5127compiled with a ``wchar_t`` width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
5128enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values::
5129
5130 !llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00005131 !0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
5132 !1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
Oliver Stannard5dc29342014-06-20 10:08:11 +00005133
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005134.. _intrinsicglobalvariables:
5135
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005136Intrinsic Global Variables
5137==========================
5138
5139LLVM has a number of "magic" global variables that contain data that
5140affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
5141All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
5142"``llvm.metadata``". This section and all globals that start with
5143"``llvm.``" are reserved for use by LLVM.
5144
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005145.. _gv_llvmused:
5146
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005147The '``llvm.used``' Global Variable
5148-----------------------------------
5149
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00005150The ``@llvm.used`` global is an array which has
Paul Redmond219ef812013-05-30 17:24:32 +00005151:ref:`appending linkage <linkage_appending>`. This array contains a list of
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00005152pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
5153have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005154use of it is:
5155
5156.. code-block:: llvm
5157
5158 @X = global i8 4
5159 @Y = global i32 123
5160
5161 @llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
5162 i8* @X,
5163 i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
5164 ], section "llvm.metadata"
5165
Rafael Espindola74f2e462013-04-22 14:58:02 +00005166If a symbol appears in the ``@llvm.used`` list, then the compiler, assembler,
5167and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
Rafael Espindola70a729d2013-06-11 13:18:13 +00005168symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
5169a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
5170``@llvm.used`` list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
5171references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot "see", and
5172corresponds to "``attribute((used))``" in GNU C.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005173
5174On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the
5175assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from
5176molesting the symbol.
5177
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005178.. _gv_llvmcompilerused:
5179
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005180The '``llvm.compiler.used``' Global Variable
5181--------------------------------------------
5182
5183The ``@llvm.compiler.used`` directive is the same as the ``@llvm.used``
5184directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
5185symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
5186optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
5187by ``@llvm.used``.
5188
5189This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances,
5190and should not be exposed to source languages.
5191
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005192.. _gv_llvmglobalctors:
5193
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005194The '``llvm.global_ctors``' Global Variable
5195-------------------------------------------
5196
5197.. code-block:: llvm
5198
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005199 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
5200 @llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005201
5202The ``@llvm.global_ctors`` array contains a list of constructor
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005203functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
5204The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
5205of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
5206functions with the same priority is not defined.
5207
5208If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
5209or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated
5210data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005211
Eli Bendersky0220e6b2013-06-07 20:24:43 +00005212.. _llvmglobaldtors:
5213
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005214The '``llvm.global_dtors``' Global Variable
5215-------------------------------------------
5216
5217.. code-block:: llvm
5218
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005219 %0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
5220 @llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005221
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005222The ``@llvm.global_dtors`` array contains a list of destructor
5223functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
5224The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
Reid Klecknerbffbcc52014-05-27 21:35:17 +00005225order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
Reid Klecknerfceb76f2014-05-16 20:39:27 +00005226order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
5227
5228If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable
5229or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated
5230data from the current module is not discarded.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005231
5232Instruction Reference
5233=====================
5234
5235The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications
5236of instructions: :ref:`terminator instructions <terminators>`, :ref:`binary
5237instructions <binaryops>`, :ref:`bitwise binary
5238instructions <bitwiseops>`, :ref:`memory instructions <memoryops>`, and
5239:ref:`other instructions <otherops>`.
5240
5241.. _terminators:
5242
5243Terminator Instructions
5244-----------------------
5245
5246As mentioned :ref:`previously <functionstructure>`, every basic block in a
5247program ends with a "Terminator" instruction, which indicates which
5248block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
5249terminator instructions typically yield a '``void``' value: they produce
5250control flow, not values (the one exception being the
5251':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`' instruction).
5252
5253The terminator instructions are: ':ref:`ret <i_ret>`',
5254':ref:`br <i_br>`', ':ref:`switch <i_switch>`',
5255':ref:`indirectbr <i_indirectbr>`', ':ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`',
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005256':ref:`resume <i_resume>`', ':ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>`',
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005257':ref:`catchret <i_catchret>`',
5258':ref:`cleanupret <i_cleanupret>`',
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005259and ':ref:`unreachable <i_unreachable>`'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005260
5261.. _i_ret:
5262
5263'``ret``' Instruction
5264^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5265
5266Syntax:
5267"""""""
5268
5269::
5270
5271 ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
5272 ret void ; Return from void function
5273
5274Overview:
5275"""""""""
5276
5277The '``ret``' instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
5278a value) from a function back to the caller.
5279
5280There are two forms of the '``ret``' instruction: one that returns a
5281value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
5282flow to occur.
5283
5284Arguments:
5285""""""""""
5286
5287The '``ret``' instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
5288return value. The type of the return value must be a ':ref:`first
5289class <t_firstclass>`' type.
5290
5291A function is not :ref:`well formed <wellformed>` if it it has a non-void
5292return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with no return value or
5293a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
5294void return type and contains a '``ret``' instruction with a return
5295value.
5296
5297Semantics:
5298""""""""""
5299
5300When the '``ret``' instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
5301the calling function's context. If the caller is a
5302":ref:`call <i_call>`" instruction, execution continues at the
5303instruction after the call. If the caller was an
5304":ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`" instruction, execution continues at the
5305beginning of the "normal" destination block. If the instruction returns
5306a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction's return
5307value.
5308
5309Example:
5310""""""""
5311
5312.. code-block:: llvm
5313
5314 ret i32 5 ; Return an integer value of 5
5315 ret void ; Return from a void function
5316 ret { i32, i8 } { i32 4, i8 2 } ; Return a struct of values 4 and 2
5317
5318.. _i_br:
5319
5320'``br``' Instruction
5321^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5322
5323Syntax:
5324"""""""
5325
5326::
5327
5328 br i1 <cond>, label <iftrue>, label <iffalse>
5329 br label <dest> ; Unconditional branch
5330
5331Overview:
5332"""""""""
5333
5334The '``br``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
5335different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
5336this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
5337unconditional branch.
5338
5339Arguments:
5340""""""""""
5341
5342The conditional branch form of the '``br``' instruction takes a single
5343'``i1``' value and two '``label``' values. The unconditional form of the
5344'``br``' instruction takes a single '``label``' value as a target.
5345
5346Semantics:
5347""""""""""
5348
5349Upon execution of a conditional '``br``' instruction, the '``i1``'
5350argument is evaluated. If the value is ``true``, control flows to the
5351'``iftrue``' ``label`` argument. If "cond" is ``false``, control flows
5352to the '``iffalse``' ``label`` argument.
5353
5354Example:
5355""""""""
5356
5357.. code-block:: llvm
5358
5359 Test:
5360 %cond = icmp eq i32 %a, %b
5361 br i1 %cond, label %IfEqual, label %IfUnequal
5362 IfEqual:
5363 ret i32 1
5364 IfUnequal:
5365 ret i32 0
5366
5367.. _i_switch:
5368
5369'``switch``' Instruction
5370^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5371
5372Syntax:
5373"""""""
5374
5375::
5376
5377 switch <intty> <value>, label <defaultdest> [ <intty> <val>, label <dest> ... ]
5378
5379Overview:
5380"""""""""
5381
5382The '``switch``' instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
5383several different places. It is a generalization of the '``br``'
5384instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
5385destinations.
5386
5387Arguments:
5388""""""""""
5389
5390The '``switch``' instruction uses three parameters: an integer
5391comparison value '``value``', a default '``label``' destination, and an
5392array of pairs of comparison value constants and '``label``'s. The table
5393is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
5394
5395Semantics:
5396""""""""""
5397
5398The ``switch`` instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
5399When the '``switch``' instruction is executed, this table is searched
5400for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
5401to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
5402to the default destination.
5403
5404Implementation:
5405"""""""""""""""
5406
5407Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
5408``switch`` instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
5409different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
5410chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
5411
5412Example:
5413""""""""
5414
5415.. code-block:: llvm
5416
5417 ; Emulate a conditional br instruction
5418 %Val = zext i1 %value to i32
5419 switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
5420
5421 ; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
5422 switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
5423
5424 ; Implement a jump table:
5425 switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
5426 i32 1, label %onone
5427 i32 2, label %ontwo ]
5428
5429.. _i_indirectbr:
5430
5431'``indirectbr``' Instruction
5432^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5433
5434Syntax:
5435"""""""
5436
5437::
5438
5439 indirectbr <somety>* <address>, [ label <dest1>, label <dest2>, ... ]
5440
5441Overview:
5442"""""""""
5443
5444The '``indirectbr``' instruction implements an indirect branch to a
5445label within the current function, whose address is specified by
5446"``address``". Address must be derived from a
5447:ref:`blockaddress <blockaddress>` constant.
5448
5449Arguments:
5450""""""""""
5451
5452The '``address``' argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
5453rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
5454that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
5455times in the destination list, though this isn't particularly useful.
5456
5457This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an
5458accurate understanding of the CFG.
5459
5460Semantics:
5461""""""""""
5462
5463Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All
5464possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise
5465this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to
5466labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
5467
5468Implementation:
5469"""""""""""""""
5470
5471This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
5472
5473Example:
5474""""""""
5475
5476.. code-block:: llvm
5477
5478 indirectbr i8* %Addr, [ label %bb1, label %bb2, label %bb3 ]
5479
5480.. _i_invoke:
5481
5482'``invoke``' Instruction
5483^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5484
5485Syntax:
5486"""""""
5487
5488::
5489
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00005490 <result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00005491 [operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005492
5493Overview:
5494"""""""""
5495
5496The '``invoke``' instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
5497function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
5498'``normal``' label or the '``exception``' label. If the callee function
5499returns with the "``ret``" instruction, control flow will return to the
5500"normal" label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
5501":ref:`resume <i_resume>`" instruction or other exception handling
5502mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
5503nearest "exception" label.
5504
5505The '``exception``' label is a `landing
5506pad <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ for the exception. As such,
5507'``exception``' label is required to have the
5508":ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>`" instruction, which contains the
5509information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
5510as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
5511"``landingpad``" instruction's tightly couples it to the "``invoke``"
5512instruction, so that the important information contained within the
5513"``landingpad``" instruction can't be lost through normal code motion.
5514
5515Arguments:
5516""""""""""
5517
5518This instruction requires several arguments:
5519
5520#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
5521 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
5522 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
5523#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
5524 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
5525 are valid here.
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00005526#. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
5527 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
5528 ``void``.
5529#. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being invoked. The
5530 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
5531 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
5532#. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
5533 be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but
5534 indirect ``invoke``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
5535 to function value.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005536#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
5537 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
5538 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
5539 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
5540 extra arguments can be specified.
5541#. '``normal label``': the label reached when the called function
5542 executes a '``ret``' instruction.
5543#. '``exception label``': the label reached when a callee returns via
5544 the :ref:`resume <i_resume>` instruction or other exception handling
5545 mechanism.
5546#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
5547 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' and '``readnone``'
5548 attributes are valid here.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00005549#. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005550
5551Semantics:
5552""""""""""
5553
5554This instruction is designed to operate as a standard '``call``'
5555instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
5556establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
5557library to unwind the stack.
5558
5559This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
5560proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a ``longjmp`` or a
5561thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
5562'``catch``' clauses in high-level languages that support them.
5563
5564For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
5565by the '``invoke``' instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
5566current block to the "normal" label. If the callee unwinds then no
5567return value is available.
5568
5569Example:
5570""""""""
5571
5572.. code-block:: llvm
5573
5574 %retval = invoke i32 @Test(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005575 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005576 %retval = invoke coldcc i32 %Testfnptr(i32 15) to label %Continue
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005577 unwind label %TestCleanup ; i32:retval set
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005578
5579.. _i_resume:
5580
5581'``resume``' Instruction
5582^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5583
5584Syntax:
5585"""""""
5586
5587::
5588
5589 resume <type> <value>
5590
5591Overview:
5592"""""""""
5593
5594The '``resume``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has no
5595successors.
5596
5597Arguments:
5598""""""""""
5599
5600The '``resume``' instruction requires one argument, which must have the
5601same type as the result of any '``landingpad``' instruction in the same
5602function.
5603
5604Semantics:
5605""""""""""
5606
5607The '``resume``' instruction resumes propagation of an existing
5608(in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
5609:ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction.
5610
5611Example:
5612""""""""
5613
5614.. code-block:: llvm
5615
5616 resume { i8*, i32 } %exn
5617
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005618.. _i_catchswitch:
5619
5620'``catchswitch``' Instruction
Akira Hatanakacedf8e92015-12-14 05:15:40 +00005621^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005622
5623Syntax:
5624"""""""
5625
5626::
5627
5628 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
5629 <resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
5630
5631Overview:
5632"""""""""
5633
5634The '``catchswitch``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling system
5635<ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to describe the set of possible catch handlers
5636that may be executed by the :ref:`EH personality routine <personalityfn>`.
5637
5638Arguments:
5639""""""""""
5640
5641The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
5642``catchswitch`` instruction. If the ``catchswitch`` is not inside a funclet,
5643this operand may be the token ``none``.
5644
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00005645The ``default`` argument is the label of another basic block beginning with
5646either a ``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination
5647must be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in
5648the `exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005649
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00005650The ``handlers`` are a nonempty list of successor blocks that each begin with a
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005651:ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction.
5652
5653Semantics:
5654""""""""""
5655
5656Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
5657``handlers``, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
5658present.
5659
5660The ``catchswitch`` is both a terminator and a "pad" instruction, meaning that
5661it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
5662block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
5663
5664Example:
5665""""""""
5666
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00005667.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005668
5669 dispatch1:
5670 %cs1 = catchswitch within none [label %handler0, label %handler1] unwind to caller
5671 dispatch2:
5672 %cs2 = catchswitch within %parenthandler [label %handler0] unwind label %cleanup
5673
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005674.. _i_catchret:
5675
5676'``catchret``' Instruction
5677^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5678
5679Syntax:
5680"""""""
5681
5682::
5683
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005684 catchret from <token> to label <normal>
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005685
5686Overview:
5687"""""""""
5688
5689The '``catchret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has a
5690single successor.
5691
5692
5693Arguments:
5694""""""""""
5695
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00005696The first argument to a '``catchret``' indicates which ``catchpad`` it
5697exits. It must be a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>`.
5698The second argument to a '``catchret``' specifies where control will
5699transfer to next.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005700
5701Semantics:
5702""""""""""
5703
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005704The '``catchret``' instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
5705unwinding was interrupted with a :ref:`catchpad <i_catchpad>` instruction. The
5706:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` gets a chance to execute arbitrary
5707code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
5708``normal``.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00005709
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00005710The ``token`` argument must be a token produced by a ``catchpad`` instruction.
5711If the specified ``catchpad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
5712funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
5713the ``catchret``'s behavior is undefined.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005714
5715Example:
5716""""""""
5717
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00005718.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005719
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005720 catchret from %catch label %continue
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00005721
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005722.. _i_cleanupret:
5723
5724'``cleanupret``' Instruction
5725^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5726
5727Syntax:
5728"""""""
5729
5730::
5731
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005732 cleanupret from <value> unwind label <continue>
5733 cleanupret from <value> unwind to caller
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005734
5735Overview:
5736"""""""""
5737
5738The '``cleanupret``' instruction is a terminator instruction that has
5739an optional successor.
5740
5741
5742Arguments:
5743""""""""""
5744
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00005745The '``cleanupret``' instruction requires one argument, which indicates
5746which ``cleanuppad`` it exits, and must be a :ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>`.
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00005747If the specified ``cleanuppad`` is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
5748funclet pad (as described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
5749the ``cleanupret``'s behavior is undefined.
5750
5751The '``cleanupret``' instruction also has an optional successor, ``continue``,
5752which must be the label of another basic block beginning with either a
5753``cleanuppad`` or ``catchswitch`` instruction. This unwind destination must
5754be a legal target with respect to the ``parent`` links, as described in the
5755`exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005756
5757Semantics:
5758""""""""""
5759
5760The '``cleanupret``' instruction indicates to the
5761:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` that one
5762:ref:`cleanuppad <i_cleanuppad>` it transferred control to has ended.
5763It transfers control to ``continue`` or unwinds out of the function.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00005764
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005765Example:
5766""""""""
5767
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00005768.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005769
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00005770 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind to caller
5771 cleanupret from %cleanup unwind label %continue
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00005772
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005773.. _i_unreachable:
5774
5775'``unreachable``' Instruction
5776^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5777
5778Syntax:
5779"""""""
5780
5781::
5782
5783 unreachable
5784
5785Overview:
5786"""""""""
5787
5788The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics. This
5789instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
5790the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
5791after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
5792
5793Semantics:
5794""""""""""
5795
5796The '``unreachable``' instruction has no defined semantics.
5797
5798.. _binaryops:
5799
5800Binary Operations
5801-----------------
5802
5803Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program.
5804They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on
5805them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple
5806data, as is the case with the :ref:`vector <t_vector>` data type. The
5807result value has the same type as its operands.
5808
5809There are several different binary operators:
5810
5811.. _i_add:
5812
5813'``add``' Instruction
5814^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5815
5816Syntax:
5817"""""""
5818
5819::
5820
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005821 <result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5822 <result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5823 <result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5824 <result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005825
5826Overview:
5827"""""""""
5828
5829The '``add``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
5830
5831Arguments:
5832""""""""""
5833
5834The two arguments to the '``add``' instruction must be
5835:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5836arguments must have identical types.
5837
5838Semantics:
5839""""""""""
5840
5841The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
5842
5843If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
5844mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
5845the result.
5846
5847Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
5848instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
5849
5850``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5851respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5852result value of the ``add`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5853unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5854
5855Example:
5856""""""""
5857
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00005858.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005859
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005860 <result> = add i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005861
5862.. _i_fadd:
5863
5864'``fadd``' Instruction
5865^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5866
5867Syntax:
5868"""""""
5869
5870::
5871
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005872 <result> = fadd [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005873
5874Overview:
5875"""""""""
5876
5877The '``fadd``' instruction returns the sum of its two operands.
5878
5879Arguments:
5880""""""""""
5881
5882The two arguments to the '``fadd``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5883point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5884Both arguments must have identical types.
5885
5886Semantics:
5887""""""""""
5888
5889The value produced is the floating point sum of the two operands. This
5890instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`,
5891which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point
5892optimizations:
5893
5894Example:
5895""""""""
5896
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00005897.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005898
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005899 <result> = fadd float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 + %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005900
5901'``sub``' Instruction
5902^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5903
5904Syntax:
5905"""""""
5906
5907::
5908
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005909 <result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5910 <result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5911 <result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
5912 <result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005913
5914Overview:
5915"""""""""
5916
5917The '``sub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
5918
5919Note that the '``sub``' instruction is used to represent the '``neg``'
5920instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
5921
5922Arguments:
5923""""""""""
5924
5925The two arguments to the '``sub``' instruction must be
5926:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
5927arguments must have identical types.
5928
5929Semantics:
5930""""""""""
5931
5932The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
5933
5934If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the
5935mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
5936the result.
5937
5938Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, this
5939instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
5940
5941``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
5942respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
5943result value of the ``sub`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
5944unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
5945
5946Example:
5947""""""""
5948
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00005949.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005950
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005951 <result> = sub i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 - %var
5952 <result> = sub i32 0, %val ; yields i32:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005953
5954.. _i_fsub:
5955
5956'``fsub``' Instruction
5957^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5958
5959Syntax:
5960"""""""
5961
5962::
5963
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005964 <result> = fsub [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005965
5966Overview:
5967"""""""""
5968
5969The '``fsub``' instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
5970
5971Note that the '``fsub``' instruction is used to represent the '``fneg``'
5972instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
5973
5974Arguments:
5975""""""""""
5976
5977The two arguments to the '``fsub``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
5978point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
5979Both arguments must have identical types.
5980
5981Semantics:
5982""""""""""
5983
5984The value produced is the floating point difference of the two operands.
5985This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
5986flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
5987unsafe floating point optimizations:
5988
5989Example:
5990""""""""
5991
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00005992.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005993
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00005994 <result> = fsub float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 - %var
5995 <result> = fsub float -0.0, %val ; yields float:result = -%var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00005996
5997'``mul``' Instruction
5998^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
5999
6000Syntax:
6001"""""""
6002
6003::
6004
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006005 <result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6006 <result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6007 <result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6008 <result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006009
6010Overview:
6011"""""""""
6012
6013The '``mul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
6014
6015Arguments:
6016""""""""""
6017
6018The two arguments to the '``mul``' instruction must be
6019:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6020arguments must have identical types.
6021
6022Semantics:
6023""""""""""
6024
6025The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
6026
6027If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result
6028returned is the mathematical result modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the
6029bit width of the result.
6030
6031Because LLVM integers use a two's complement representation, and the
6032result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
6033correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
6034(e.g. ``i32`` * ``i32`` -> ``i64``) is needed, the operands should be
6035sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
6036product.
6037
6038``nuw`` and ``nsw`` stand for "No Unsigned Wrap" and "No Signed Wrap",
6039respectively. If the ``nuw`` and/or ``nsw`` keywords are present, the
6040result value of the ``mul`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if
6041unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
6042
6043Example:
6044""""""""
6045
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006046.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006047
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006048 <result> = mul i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006049
6050.. _i_fmul:
6051
6052'``fmul``' Instruction
6053^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6054
6055Syntax:
6056"""""""
6057
6058::
6059
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006060 <result> = fmul [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006061
6062Overview:
6063"""""""""
6064
6065The '``fmul``' instruction returns the product of its two operands.
6066
6067Arguments:
6068""""""""""
6069
6070The two arguments to the '``fmul``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
6071point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
6072Both arguments must have identical types.
6073
6074Semantics:
6075""""""""""
6076
6077The value produced is the floating point product of the two operands.
6078This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6079flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
6080unsafe floating point optimizations:
6081
6082Example:
6083""""""""
6084
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006085.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006086
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006087 <result> = fmul float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 * %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006088
6089'``udiv``' Instruction
6090^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6091
6092Syntax:
6093"""""""
6094
6095::
6096
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006097 <result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6098 <result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006099
6100Overview:
6101"""""""""
6102
6103The '``udiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
6104
6105Arguments:
6106""""""""""
6107
6108The two arguments to the '``udiv``' instruction must be
6109:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6110arguments must have identical types.
6111
6112Semantics:
6113""""""""""
6114
6115The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
6116
6117Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
6118distinct operations; for signed integer division, use '``sdiv``'.
6119
6120Division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
6121
6122If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``udiv`` is
6123a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
6124such, "((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a").
6125
6126Example:
6127""""""""
6128
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006129.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006130
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006131 <result> = udiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006132
6133'``sdiv``' Instruction
6134^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6135
6136Syntax:
6137"""""""
6138
6139::
6140
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006141 <result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6142 <result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006143
6144Overview:
6145"""""""""
6146
6147The '``sdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
6148
6149Arguments:
6150""""""""""
6151
6152The two arguments to the '``sdiv``' instruction must be
6153:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6154arguments must have identical types.
6155
6156Semantics:
6157""""""""""
6158
6159The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands
6160rounded towards zero.
6161
6162Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
6163distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use '``udiv``'.
6164
6165Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to
6166undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by
6167doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
6168
6169If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``sdiv`` is
6170a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the result would be rounded.
6171
6172Example:
6173""""""""
6174
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006175.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006176
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006177 <result> = sdiv i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006178
6179.. _i_fdiv:
6180
6181'``fdiv``' Instruction
6182^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6183
6184Syntax:
6185"""""""
6186
6187::
6188
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006189 <result> = fdiv [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006190
6191Overview:
6192"""""""""
6193
6194The '``fdiv``' instruction returns the quotient of its two operands.
6195
6196Arguments:
6197""""""""""
6198
6199The two arguments to the '``fdiv``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
6200point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
6201Both arguments must have identical types.
6202
6203Semantics:
6204""""""""""
6205
6206The value produced is the floating point quotient of the two operands.
6207This instruction can also take any number of :ref:`fast-math
6208flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise
6209unsafe floating point optimizations:
6210
6211Example:
6212""""""""
6213
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006214.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006215
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006216 <result> = fdiv float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 / %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006217
6218'``urem``' Instruction
6219^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6220
6221Syntax:
6222"""""""
6223
6224::
6225
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006226 <result> = urem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006227
6228Overview:
6229"""""""""
6230
6231The '``urem``' instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
6232division of its two arguments.
6233
6234Arguments:
6235""""""""""
6236
6237The two arguments to the '``urem``' instruction must be
6238:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6239arguments must have identical types.
6240
6241Semantics:
6242""""""""""
6243
6244This instruction returns the unsigned integer *remainder* of a division.
6245This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the
6246remainder.
6247
6248Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
6249distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use '``srem``'.
6250
6251Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
6252
6253Example:
6254""""""""
6255
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006256.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006257
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006258 <result> = urem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006259
6260'``srem``' Instruction
6261^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6262
6263Syntax:
6264"""""""
6265
6266::
6267
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006268 <result> = srem <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006269
6270Overview:
6271"""""""""
6272
6273The '``srem``' instruction returns the remainder from the signed
6274division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
6275:ref:`vector <t_vector>` versions of the values in which case the elements
6276must be integers.
6277
6278Arguments:
6279""""""""""
6280
6281The two arguments to the '``srem``' instruction must be
6282:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6283arguments must have identical types.
6284
6285Semantics:
6286""""""""""
6287
6288This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division (where the result
6289is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, ``op1``), not the
6290*modulo* operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
6291as the divisor, ``op2``) of a value. For more information about the
6292difference, see `The Math
6293Forum <http://mathforum.org/dr.math/problems/anne.4.28.99.html>`_. For a
6294table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
6295`Wikipedia: modulo
6296operation <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Modulo_operation>`_.
6297
6298Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
6299distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use '``urem``'.
6300
6301Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
6302Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can
6303occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of
6304-2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn't actually overflow, but this
6305rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the
6306result of the division and the remainder.)
6307
6308Example:
6309""""""""
6310
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006311.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006312
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006313 <result> = srem i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006314
6315.. _i_frem:
6316
6317'``frem``' Instruction
6318^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6319
6320Syntax:
6321"""""""
6322
6323::
6324
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006325 <result> = frem [fast-math flags]* <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006326
6327Overview:
6328"""""""""
6329
6330The '``frem``' instruction returns the remainder from the division of
6331its two operands.
6332
6333Arguments:
6334""""""""""
6335
6336The two arguments to the '``frem``' instruction must be :ref:`floating
6337point <t_floating>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point values.
6338Both arguments must have identical types.
6339
6340Semantics:
6341""""""""""
6342
6343This instruction returns the *remainder* of a division. The remainder
6344has the same sign as the dividend. This instruction can also take any
6345number of :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints
6346to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
6347
6348Example:
6349""""""""
6350
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006351.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006352
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006353 <result> = frem float 4.0, %var ; yields float:result = 4.0 % %var
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006354
6355.. _bitwiseops:
6356
6357Bitwise Binary Operations
6358-------------------------
6359
6360Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling
6361in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can
6362commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two
6363operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a
6364single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
6365
6366'``shl``' Instruction
6367^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6368
6369Syntax:
6370"""""""
6371
6372::
6373
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006374 <result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6375 <result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6376 <result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6377 <result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006378
6379Overview:
6380"""""""""
6381
6382The '``shl``' instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
6383a specified number of bits.
6384
6385Arguments:
6386""""""""""
6387
6388Both arguments to the '``shl``' instruction must be the same
6389:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6390'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6391
6392Semantics:
6393""""""""""
6394
6395The value produced is ``op1`` \* 2\ :sup:`op2` mod 2\ :sup:`n`,
6396where ``n`` is the width of the result. If ``op2`` is (statically or
Sean Silvab8a108c2015-04-17 21:58:55 +00006397dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006398``op1``, the result is undefined. If the arguments are vectors, each
6399vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the corresponding shift amount
6400in ``op2``.
6401
6402If the ``nuw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
6403value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any non-zero bits. If the
6404``nsw`` keyword is present, then the shift produces a :ref:`poison
6405value <poisonvalues>` if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the
6406resultant sign bit. As such, NUW/NSW have the same semantics as they
6407would if the shift were expressed as a mul instruction with the same
6408nsw/nuw bits in (mul %op1, (shl 1, %op2)).
6409
6410Example:
6411""""""""
6412
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006413.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006414
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006415 <result> = shl i32 4, %var ; yields i32: 4 << %var
6416 <result> = shl i32 4, 2 ; yields i32: 16
6417 <result> = shl i32 1, 10 ; yields i32: 1024
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006418 <result> = shl i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6419 <result> = shl <2 x i32> < i32 1, i32 1>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 2, i32 4>
6420
6421'``lshr``' Instruction
6422^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6423
6424Syntax:
6425"""""""
6426
6427::
6428
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006429 <result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6430 <result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006431
6432Overview:
6433"""""""""
6434
6435The '``lshr``' instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
6436operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
6437
6438Arguments:
6439""""""""""
6440
6441Both arguments to the '``lshr``' instruction must be the same
6442:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6443'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6444
6445Semantics:
6446""""""""""
6447
6448This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
6449most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
6450the shift. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
6451than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
6452arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
6453corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
6454
6455If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``lshr`` is
6456a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
6457non-zero.
6458
6459Example:
6460""""""""
6461
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006462.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006463
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006464 <result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
6465 <result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
6466 <result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
6467 <result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006468 <result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6469 <result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
6470
6471'``ashr``' Instruction
6472^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6473
6474Syntax:
6475"""""""
6476
6477::
6478
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006479 <result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
6480 <result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006481
6482Overview:
6483"""""""""
6484
6485The '``ashr``' instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
6486operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
6487extension.
6488
6489Arguments:
6490""""""""""
6491
6492Both arguments to the '``ashr``' instruction must be the same
6493:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer type.
6494'``op2``' is treated as an unsigned value.
6495
6496Semantics:
6497""""""""""
6498
6499This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
6500The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
6501of ``op1``. If ``op2`` is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
6502than the number of bits in ``op1``, the result is undefined. If the
6503arguments are vectors, each vector element of ``op1`` is shifted by the
6504corresponding shift amount in ``op2``.
6505
6506If the ``exact`` keyword is present, the result value of the ``ashr`` is
6507a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if any of the bits shifted out are
6508non-zero.
6509
6510Example:
6511""""""""
6512
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006513.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006514
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006515 <result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
6516 <result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
6517 <result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
6518 <result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006519 <result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
6520 <result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
6521
6522'``and``' Instruction
6523^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6524
6525Syntax:
6526"""""""
6527
6528::
6529
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006530 <result> = and <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006531
6532Overview:
6533"""""""""
6534
6535The '``and``' instruction returns the bitwise logical and of its two
6536operands.
6537
6538Arguments:
6539""""""""""
6540
6541The two arguments to the '``and``' instruction must be
6542:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6543arguments must have identical types.
6544
6545Semantics:
6546""""""""""
6547
6548The truth table used for the '``and``' instruction is:
6549
6550+-----+-----+-----+
6551| In0 | In1 | Out |
6552+-----+-----+-----+
6553| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6554+-----+-----+-----+
6555| 0 | 1 | 0 |
6556+-----+-----+-----+
6557| 1 | 0 | 0 |
6558+-----+-----+-----+
6559| 1 | 1 | 1 |
6560+-----+-----+-----+
6561
6562Example:
6563""""""""
6564
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006565.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006566
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006567 <result> = and i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 & %var
6568 <result> = and i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 8
6569 <result> = and i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006570
6571'``or``' Instruction
6572^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6573
6574Syntax:
6575"""""""
6576
6577::
6578
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006579 <result> = or <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006580
6581Overview:
6582"""""""""
6583
6584The '``or``' instruction returns the bitwise logical inclusive or of its
6585two operands.
6586
6587Arguments:
6588""""""""""
6589
6590The two arguments to the '``or``' instruction must be
6591:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6592arguments must have identical types.
6593
6594Semantics:
6595""""""""""
6596
6597The truth table used for the '``or``' instruction is:
6598
6599+-----+-----+-----+
6600| In0 | In1 | Out |
6601+-----+-----+-----+
6602| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6603+-----+-----+-----+
6604| 0 | 1 | 1 |
6605+-----+-----+-----+
6606| 1 | 0 | 1 |
6607+-----+-----+-----+
6608| 1 | 1 | 1 |
6609+-----+-----+-----+
6610
6611Example:
6612""""""""
6613
6614::
6615
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006616 <result> = or i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 | %var
6617 <result> = or i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 47
6618 <result> = or i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006619
6620'``xor``' Instruction
6621^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6622
6623Syntax:
6624"""""""
6625
6626::
6627
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006628 <result> = xor <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006629
6630Overview:
6631"""""""""
6632
6633The '``xor``' instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
6634its two operands. The ``xor`` is used to implement the "one's
6635complement" operation, which is the "~" operator in C.
6636
6637Arguments:
6638""""""""""
6639
6640The two arguments to the '``xor``' instruction must be
6641:ref:`integer <t_integer>` or :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of integer values. Both
6642arguments must have identical types.
6643
6644Semantics:
6645""""""""""
6646
6647The truth table used for the '``xor``' instruction is:
6648
6649+-----+-----+-----+
6650| In0 | In1 | Out |
6651+-----+-----+-----+
6652| 0 | 0 | 0 |
6653+-----+-----+-----+
6654| 0 | 1 | 1 |
6655+-----+-----+-----+
6656| 1 | 0 | 1 |
6657+-----+-----+-----+
6658| 1 | 1 | 0 |
6659+-----+-----+-----+
6660
6661Example:
6662""""""""
6663
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006664.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006665
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006666 <result> = xor i32 4, %var ; yields i32:result = 4 ^ %var
6667 <result> = xor i32 15, 40 ; yields i32:result = 39
6668 <result> = xor i32 4, 8 ; yields i32:result = 12
6669 <result> = xor i32 %V, -1 ; yields i32:result = ~%V
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006670
6671Vector Operations
6672-----------------
6673
6674LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a
6675target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access
6676and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively.
6677While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many
6678sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to
6679take full advantage of a specific target.
6680
6681.. _i_extractelement:
6682
6683'``extractelement``' Instruction
6684^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6685
6686Syntax:
6687"""""""
6688
6689::
6690
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006691 <result> = extractelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <ty>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006692
6693Overview:
6694"""""""""
6695
6696The '``extractelement``' instruction extracts a single scalar element
6697from a vector at a specified index.
6698
6699Arguments:
6700""""""""""
6701
6702The first operand of an '``extractelement``' instruction is a value of
6703:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is an index indicating
6704the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006705variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006706
6707Semantics:
6708""""""""""
6709
6710The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of ``val``.
6711Its value is the value at position ``idx`` of ``val``. If ``idx``
6712exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are undefined.
6713
6714Example:
6715""""""""
6716
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006717.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006718
6719 <result> = extractelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 0 ; yields i32
6720
6721.. _i_insertelement:
6722
6723'``insertelement``' Instruction
6724^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6725
6726Syntax:
6727"""""""
6728
6729::
6730
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006731 <result> = insertelement <n x <ty>> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <ty2> <idx> ; yields <n x <ty>>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006732
6733Overview:
6734"""""""""
6735
6736The '``insertelement``' instruction inserts a scalar element into a
6737vector at a specified index.
6738
6739Arguments:
6740""""""""""
6741
6742The first operand of an '``insertelement``' instruction is a value of
6743:ref:`vector <t_vector>` type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
6744type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
6745is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
Michael J. Spencer1f10c5ea2014-05-01 22:12:39 +00006746index may be a variable of any integer type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006747
6748Semantics:
6749""""""""""
6750
6751The result is a vector of the same type as ``val``. Its element values
6752are those of ``val`` except at position ``idx``, where it gets the value
6753``elt``. If ``idx`` exceeds the length of ``val``, the results are
6754undefined.
6755
6756Example:
6757""""""""
6758
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006759.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006760
6761 <result> = insertelement <4 x i32> %vec, i32 1, i32 0 ; yields <4 x i32>
6762
6763.. _i_shufflevector:
6764
6765'``shufflevector``' Instruction
6766^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6767
6768Syntax:
6769"""""""
6770
6771::
6772
6773 <result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
6774
6775Overview:
6776"""""""""
6777
6778The '``shufflevector``' instruction constructs a permutation of elements
6779from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
6780the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
6781
6782Arguments:
6783""""""""""
6784
6785The first two operands of a '``shufflevector``' instruction are vectors
6786with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
6787type is always 'i32'. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
6788length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
6789same as the element type of the first two operands.
6790
6791The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either
6792constant integer or undef values.
6793
6794Semantics:
6795""""""""""
6796
6797The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right
6798across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each
6799element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the
6800result element gets. The element selector may be undef (meaning "don't
6801care") and the second operand may be undef if performing a shuffle from
6802only one vector.
6803
6804Example:
6805""""""""
6806
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006807.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006808
6809 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
6810 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
6811 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
6812 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
6813 <result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
6814 <4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
6815 <result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
6816 <8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
6817
6818Aggregate Operations
6819--------------------
6820
6821LLVM supports several instructions for working with
6822:ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` values.
6823
6824.. _i_extractvalue:
6825
6826'``extractvalue``' Instruction
6827^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6828
6829Syntax:
6830"""""""
6831
6832::
6833
6834 <result> = extractvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <idx>{, <idx>}*
6835
6836Overview:
6837"""""""""
6838
6839The '``extractvalue``' instruction extracts the value of a member field
6840from an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
6841
6842Arguments:
6843""""""""""
6844
6845The first operand of an '``extractvalue``' instruction is a value of
Arch D. Robisona7f8f252015-10-14 19:10:45 +00006846:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The other operands are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006847constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
6848as indices in a '``getelementptr``' instruction.
6849
6850The major differences to ``getelementptr`` indexing are:
6851
6852- Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is
6853 omitted and assumed to be zero.
6854- At least one index must be specified.
6855- Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
6856
6857Semantics:
6858""""""""""
6859
6860The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by
6861the index operands.
6862
6863Example:
6864""""""""
6865
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00006866.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006867
6868 <result> = extractvalue {i32, float} %agg, 0 ; yields i32
6869
6870.. _i_insertvalue:
6871
6872'``insertvalue``' Instruction
6873^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6874
6875Syntax:
6876"""""""
6877
6878::
6879
6880 <result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
6881
6882Overview:
6883"""""""""
6884
6885The '``insertvalue``' instruction inserts a value into a member field in
6886an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` value.
6887
6888Arguments:
6889""""""""""
6890
6891The first operand of an '``insertvalue``' instruction is a value of
6892:ref:`struct <t_struct>` or :ref:`array <t_array>` type. The second operand is
6893a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
6894indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
6895similar manner as indices in a '``extractvalue``' instruction. The value
6896to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
6897indices.
6898
6899Semantics:
6900""""""""""
6901
6902The result is an aggregate of the same type as ``val``. Its value is
6903that of ``val`` except that the value at the position specified by the
6904indices is that of ``elt``.
6905
6906Example:
6907""""""""
6908
6909.. code-block:: llvm
6910
6911 %agg1 = insertvalue {i32, float} undef, i32 1, 0 ; yields {i32 1, float undef}
6912 %agg2 = insertvalue {i32, float} %agg1, float %val, 1 ; yields {i32 1, float %val}
Dan Liewffcfe7f2014-09-08 21:19:46 +00006913 %agg3 = insertvalue {i32, {float}} undef, float %val, 1, 0 ; yields {i32 undef, {float %val}}
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006914
6915.. _memoryops:
6916
6917Memory Access and Addressing Operations
6918---------------------------------------
6919
6920A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents
6921memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things
6922very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate
6923memory in LLVM.
6924
6925.. _i_alloca:
6926
6927'``alloca``' Instruction
6928^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6929
6930Syntax:
6931"""""""
6932
6933::
6934
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006935 <result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] ; yields type*:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006936
6937Overview:
6938"""""""""
6939
6940The '``alloca``' instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
6941currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
6942function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
6943generic address space (address space zero).
6944
6945Arguments:
6946""""""""""
6947
6948The '``alloca``' instruction allocates ``sizeof(<type>)*NumElements``
6949bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
6950appropriate type to the program. If "NumElements" is specified, it is
6951the number of elements allocated, otherwise "NumElements" is defaulted
6952to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00006953allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
6954alignment may not be greater than ``1 << 29``. If not specified, or if
6955zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
6956boundary compatible with the type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006957
6958'``type``' may be any sized type.
6959
6960Semantics:
6961""""""""""
6962
6963Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
6964if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. '``alloca``'d
6965memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
6966'``alloca``' instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
6967variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
6968(either with the ``ret`` or ``resume`` instructions), the memory is
6969reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined.
6970The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack grows)
6971is not specified.
6972
6973Example:
6974""""""""
6975
6976.. code-block:: llvm
6977
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00006978 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
6979 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4 ; yields i32*:ptr
6980 %ptr = alloca i32, i32 4, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
6981 %ptr = alloca i32, align 1024 ; yields i32*:ptr
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006982
6983.. _i_load:
6984
6985'``load``' Instruction
6986^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
6987
6988Syntax:
6989"""""""
6990
6991::
6992
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00006993 <result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
Matt Arsenaultd5b9a362016-04-12 14:41:03 +00006994 <result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006995 !<index> = !{ i32 1 }
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00006996 !<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00006997 !<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00006998
6999Overview:
7000"""""""""
7001
7002The '``load``' instruction is used to read from memory.
7003
7004Arguments:
7005""""""""""
7006
Sanjoy Dasc2cf6ef2016-06-01 16:13:10 +00007007The argument to the ``load`` instruction specifies the memory address from which
7008to load. The type specified must be a :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of
7009known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque structural type <t_opaque>`). If
7010the ``load`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to
7011modify the number or order of execution of this ``load`` with other
7012:ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007013
JF Bastiend1fb5852015-12-17 22:09:19 +00007014If the ``load`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
7015<ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The ``release`` and
7016``acq_rel`` orderings are not valid on ``load`` instructions. Atomic loads
7017produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see multiple atomic
7018stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point
7019type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
7020than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be explicitly
7021specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the alignment
7022is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
7023pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007024
7025The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
7026operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Bendersky239a78b2013-04-17 20:17:08 +00007027or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007028alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
7029to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
7030alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
Reid Kleckner15fe7a52014-07-15 01:16:09 +00007031may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
Matt Arsenault7020f252016-06-16 16:33:41 +00007032maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment value higher
7033than the size of the loaded type implies memory up to the alignment
7034value bytes can be safely loaded without trapping in the default
7035address space. Access of the high bytes can interfere with debugging
7036tools, so should not be accessed if the function has the
7037``sanitize_thread`` or ``sanitize_address`` attributes.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007038
7039The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007040metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007041``i32`` entry of value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal``
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007042metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007043that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
7044generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
7045as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on x86.
7046
7047The optional ``!invariant.load`` metadata must reference a single
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007048metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
7049entries. The existence of the ``!invariant.load`` metadata on the
Philip Reamese1526fc2014-11-24 22:32:43 +00007050instruction tells the optimizer and code generator that the address
7051operand to this load points to memory which can be assumed unchanged.
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00007052Being invariant does not imply that a location is dereferenceable,
7053but it does imply that once the location is known dereferenceable
7054its value is henceforth unchanging.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007055
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00007056The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
7057 ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
7058
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00007059The optional ``!nonnull`` metadata must reference a single
7060metadata name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with no
7061entries. The existence of the ``!nonnull`` metadata on the
7062instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
Piotr Padlewskid97846e2015-09-02 20:33:16 +00007063never be null. This is analogous to the ``nonnull`` attribute
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00007064on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00007065to loads of a pointer type.
Philip Reamescdb72f32014-10-20 22:40:55 +00007066
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00007067The optional ``!dereferenceable`` metadata must reference a single metadata
7068name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64``
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007069entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable`` metadata on the instruction
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007070tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007071The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
7072value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable''
7073attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007074to loads of a pointer type.
7075
7076The optional ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata must reference a single
Artur Pilipenko253d71e2015-09-18 12:07:10 +00007077metadata name ``<deref_bytes_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one
7078``i64`` entry. The existence of the ``!dereferenceable_or_null`` metadata on the
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007079instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
7080dereferenceable or null.
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007081The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
7082value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ''dereferenceable_or_null''
7083attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
Sanjoy Dasf9995472015-05-19 20:10:19 +00007084to loads of a pointer type.
7085
Artur Pilipenkob4d00902015-09-28 17:41:08 +00007086The optional ``!align`` metadata must reference a single metadata name
7087``<align_node>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i64`` entry.
7088The existence of the ``!align`` metadata on the instruction tells the
7089optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
7090by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
7091This is analogous to the ''align'' attribute on parameters and return values.
7092This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
7093
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007094Semantics:
7095""""""""""
7096
7097The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
7098is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
7099minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
7100example, loading an ``i24`` reads at most three bytes. When loading a
7101value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
7102of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
7103written using a store of the same type.
7104
7105Examples:
7106"""""""""
7107
7108.. code-block:: llvm
7109
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007110 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
7111 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +00007112 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007113
7114.. _i_store:
7115
7116'``store``' Instruction
7117^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7118
7119Syntax:
7120"""""""
7121
7122::
7123
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00007124 store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
7125 store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007126
7127Overview:
7128"""""""""
7129
7130The '``store``' instruction is used to write to memory.
7131
7132Arguments:
7133""""""""""
7134
Sanjoy Dasc2cf6ef2016-06-01 16:13:10 +00007135There are two arguments to the ``store`` instruction: a value to store and an
7136address at which to store it. The type of the ``<pointer>`` operand must be a
7137pointer to the :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type of the ``<value>``
7138operand. If the ``store`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the optimizer is not
7139allowed to modify the number or order of execution of this ``store`` with other
7140:ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`. Only values of :ref:`first class
7141<t_firstclass>` types of known size (i.e. not containing an :ref:`opaque
7142structural type <t_opaque>`) can be stored.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007143
JF Bastiend1fb5852015-12-17 22:09:19 +00007144If the ``store`` is marked as ``atomic``, it takes an extra :ref:`ordering
7145<ordering>` and optional ``singlethread`` argument. The ``acquire`` and
7146``acq_rel`` orderings aren't valid on ``store`` instructions. Atomic loads
7147produce :ref:`defined <memmodel>` results when they may see multiple atomic
7148stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point
7149type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
7150than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ``align`` must be explicitly
7151specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if the
7152alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
7153pointee. ``!nontemporal`` does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007154
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007155The optional constant ``align`` argument specifies the alignment of the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007156operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007157or an omitted ``align`` argument means that the operation has the ABI
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007158alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
7159to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007160alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007161alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
Matt Arsenault7020f252016-06-16 16:33:41 +00007162safe. The maximum possible alignment is ``1 << 29``. An alignment
7163value higher than the size of the stored type implies memory up to the
7164alignment value bytes can be stored to without trapping in the default
7165address space. Storing to the higher bytes however may result in data
7166races if another thread can access the same address. Introducing a
7167data race is not allowed. Storing to the extra bytes is not allowed
7168even in situations where a data race is known to not exist if the
7169function has the ``sanitize_address`` attribute.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007170
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007171The optional ``!nontemporal`` metadata must reference a single metadata
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007172name ``<index>`` corresponding to a metadata node with one ``i32`` entry of
Stefanus Du Toit736e2e22013-06-20 14:02:44 +00007173value 1. The existence of the ``!nontemporal`` metadata on the instruction
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007174tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
7175be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
JF Bastiend2d8ffd2016-01-13 04:52:26 +00007176instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the ``MOVNT`` instruction on
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007177x86.
7178
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +00007179The optional ``!invariant.group`` metadata must reference a
7180single metadata name ``<index>``. See ``invariant.group`` metadata.
7181
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007182Semantics:
7183""""""""""
7184
Eli Benderskyca380842013-04-17 17:17:20 +00007185The contents of memory are updated to contain ``<value>`` at the
7186location specified by the ``<pointer>`` operand. If ``<value>`` is
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007187of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
7188minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
7189example, storing an ``i24`` writes at most three bytes. When writing a
7190value of a type like ``i20`` with a size that is not an integral number
7191of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
7192belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
7193
7194Example:
7195""""""""
7196
7197.. code-block:: llvm
7198
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007199 %ptr = alloca i32 ; yields i32*:ptr
7200 store i32 3, i32* %ptr ; yields void
Nick Lewycky149d04c2015-08-11 01:05:16 +00007201 %val = load i32, i32* %ptr ; yields i32:val = i32 3
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007202
7203.. _i_fence:
7204
7205'``fence``' Instruction
7206^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7207
7208Syntax:
7209"""""""
7210
7211::
7212
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007213 fence [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007214
7215Overview:
7216"""""""""
7217
7218The '``fence``' instruction is used to introduce happens-before edges
7219between operations.
7220
7221Arguments:
7222""""""""""
7223
7224'``fence``' instructions take an :ref:`ordering <ordering>` argument which
7225defines what *synchronizes-with* edges they add. They can only be given
7226``acquire``, ``release``, ``acq_rel``, and ``seq_cst`` orderings.
7227
7228Semantics:
7229""""""""""
7230
7231A fence A which has (at least) ``release`` ordering semantics
7232*synchronizes with* a fence B with (at least) ``acquire`` ordering
7233semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
7234operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
7235modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
7236headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
7237*happens-before* dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
7238``fence``, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
7239provide a ``release`` or ``acquire`` (resp.) ordering constraint and
7240still *synchronize-with* the explicit ``fence`` and establish the
7241*happens-before* edge.
7242
7243A ``fence`` which has ``seq_cst`` ordering, in addition to having both
7244``acquire`` and ``release`` semantics specified above, participates in
7245the global program order of other ``seq_cst`` operations and/or fences.
7246
7247The optional ":ref:`singlethread <singlethread>`" argument specifies
7248that the fence only synchronizes with other fences in the same thread.
7249(This is useful for interacting with signal handlers.)
7250
7251Example:
7252""""""""
7253
7254.. code-block:: llvm
7255
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007256 fence acquire ; yields void
7257 fence singlethread seq_cst ; yields void
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007258
7259.. _i_cmpxchg:
7260
7261'``cmpxchg``' Instruction
7262^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7263
7264Syntax:
7265"""""""
7266
7267::
7268
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007269 cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [singlethread] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007270
7271Overview:
7272"""""""""
7273
7274The '``cmpxchg``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
7275loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007276equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007277
7278Arguments:
7279""""""""""
7280
7281There are three arguments to the '``cmpxchg``' instruction: an address
7282to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
7283address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
Philip Reames1960cfd2016-02-19 00:06:41 +00007284are equal. The type of '<cmp>' must be an integer or pointer type whose
7285bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
7286than or equal to a target-specific size limit. '<cmp>' and '<new>' must
7287have the same type, and the type of '<pointer>' must be a pointer to
7288that type. If the ``cmpxchg`` is marked as ``volatile``, then the
7289optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of execution of
7290this ``cmpxchg`` with other :ref:`volatile operations <volatile>`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007291
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00007292The success and failure :ref:`ordering <ordering>` arguments specify how this
Tim Northover1dcc9f92014-06-13 14:24:16 +00007293``cmpxchg`` synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
7294must be at least ``monotonic``, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
7295stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
7296``release`` or ``acq_rel``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007297
7298The optional "``singlethread``" argument declares that the ``cmpxchg``
7299is only atomic with respect to code (usually signal handlers) running in
7300the same thread as the ``cmpxchg``. Otherwise the cmpxchg is atomic with
7301respect to all other code in the system.
7302
7303The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or
7304equal to the size in memory of the operand.
7305
7306Semantics:
7307""""""""""
7308
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007309The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``' operand
7310is read and compared to '``<cmp>``'; if the read value is the equal, the
7311'``<new>``' is written. The original value at the location is returned, together
7312with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
7313
7314If the cmpxchg operation is marked as ``weak`` then a spurious failure is
7315permitted: the operation may not write ``<new>`` even if the comparison
7316matched.
7317
7318If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
7319if the value loaded equals ``cmp``.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007320
Tim Northovere94a5182014-03-11 10:48:52 +00007321A successful ``cmpxchg`` is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
7322identifying release sequences. A failed ``cmpxchg`` is equivalent to an atomic
7323load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007324
7325Example:
7326""""""""
7327
7328.. code-block:: llvm
7329
7330 entry:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithc917c7a2016-02-07 05:06:35 +00007331 %orig = load atomic i32, i32* %ptr unordered, align 4 ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007332 br label %loop
7333
7334 loop:
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithc917c7a2016-02-07 05:06:35 +00007335 %cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%value_loaded, %loop]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007336 %squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007337 %val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
Tim Northover420a2162014-06-13 14:24:07 +00007338 %value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
7339 %success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007340 br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
7341
7342 done:
7343 ...
7344
7345.. _i_atomicrmw:
7346
7347'``atomicrmw``' Instruction
7348^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7349
7350Syntax:
7351"""""""
7352
7353::
7354
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007355 atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields ty
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007356
7357Overview:
7358"""""""""
7359
7360The '``atomicrmw``' instruction is used to atomically modify memory.
7361
7362Arguments:
7363""""""""""
7364
7365There are three arguments to the '``atomicrmw``' instruction: an
7366operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
7367operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
7368
7369- xchg
7370- add
7371- sub
7372- and
7373- nand
7374- or
7375- xor
7376- max
7377- min
7378- umax
7379- umin
7380
7381The type of '<value>' must be an integer type whose bit width is a power
7382of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a
7383target-specific size limit. The type of the '``<pointer>``' operand must
7384be a pointer to that type. If the ``atomicrmw`` is marked as
7385``volatile``, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or
7386order of execution of this ``atomicrmw`` with other :ref:`volatile
7387operations <volatile>`.
7388
7389Semantics:
7390""""""""""
7391
7392The contents of memory at the location specified by the '``<pointer>``'
7393operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
7394value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
7395operation argument:
7396
7397- xchg: ``*ptr = val``
7398- add: ``*ptr = *ptr + val``
7399- sub: ``*ptr = *ptr - val``
7400- and: ``*ptr = *ptr & val``
7401- nand: ``*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)``
7402- or: ``*ptr = *ptr | val``
7403- xor: ``*ptr = *ptr ^ val``
7404- max: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
7405- min: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using a signed comparison)
7406- umax: ``*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
7407 comparison)
7408- umin: ``*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val`` (using an unsigned
7409 comparison)
7410
7411Example:
7412""""""""
7413
7414.. code-block:: llvm
7415
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00007416 %old = atomicrmw add i32* %ptr, i32 1 acquire ; yields i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007417
7418.. _i_getelementptr:
7419
7420'``getelementptr``' Instruction
7421^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7422
7423Syntax:
7424"""""""
7425
7426::
7427
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007428 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
7429 <result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
7430 <result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, <vector index type> <idx>
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007431
7432Overview:
7433"""""""""
7434
7435The '``getelementptr``' instruction is used to get the address of a
7436subelement of an :ref:`aggregate <t_aggregate>` data structure. It performs
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007437address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
7438be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007439
7440Arguments:
7441""""""""""
7442
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007443The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations.
7444The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the
7445base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007446that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed.
7447The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed
7448into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the
7449first argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to
7450(not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index
7451can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer
7452value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that
7453subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that
7454would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
7455
7456The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
7457When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only ``i32`` integer
7458**constants** are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
7459be the **same** ``i32`` integer constant). When indexing into an array,
7460pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
7461required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
7462where relevant.
7463
7464For example, let's consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled
7465to LLVM:
7466
7467.. code-block:: c
7468
7469 struct RT {
7470 char A;
7471 int B[10][20];
7472 char C;
7473 };
7474 struct ST {
7475 int X;
7476 double Y;
7477 struct RT Z;
7478 };
7479
7480 int *foo(struct ST *s) {
7481 return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
7482 }
7483
7484The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
7485
7486.. code-block:: llvm
7487
7488 %struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
7489 %struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
7490
7491 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
7492 entry:
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007493 %arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007494 ret i32* %arrayidx
7495 }
7496
7497Semantics:
7498""""""""""
7499
7500In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
7501'``%struct.ST*``' type, which is a pointer, yielding a '``%struct.ST``'
7502= '``{ i32, double, %struct.RT }``' type, a structure. The second index
7503indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
7504'``%struct.RT``' = '``{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }``' type, another
7505structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
7506structure, yielding a '``[10 x [20 x i32]]``' type, an array. The two
7507dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an '``i32``'
7508type. The '``getelementptr``' instruction returns a pointer to this
7509element, thus computing a value of '``i32*``' type.
7510
7511Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure,
7512returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code
7513for the given testcase is equivalent to:
7514
7515.. code-block:: llvm
7516
7517 define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007518 %t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
7519 %t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
7520 %t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
7521 %t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
7522 %t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007523 ret i32* %t5
7524 }
7525
7526If the ``inbounds`` keyword is present, the result value of the
7527``getelementptr`` is a :ref:`poison value <poisonvalues>` if the base
7528pointer is not an *in bounds* address of an allocated object, or if any
7529of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
7530offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
7531precise signed arithmetic are not an *in bounds* address of that
7532allocated object. The *in bounds* addresses for an allocated object are
7533all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
7534past the end. In cases where the base is a vector of pointers the
7535``inbounds`` keyword applies to each of the computations element-wise.
7536
7537If the ``inbounds`` keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
7538base address with silently-wrapping two's complement arithmetic. If the
7539offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
7540or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
7541``getelementptr`` may be outside the object pointed to by the base
7542pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
7543though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
7544:ref:`Pointer Aliasing Rules <pointeraliasing>` section for more
7545information.
7546
7547The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight
7548into how it works, see :doc:`the getelementptr FAQ <GetElementPtr>`.
7549
7550Example:
7551""""""""
7552
7553.. code-block:: llvm
7554
7555 ; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007556 %aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007557 ; yields i8*:vptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007558 %vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007559 ; yields i8*:eptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007560 %eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007561 ; yields i32*:iptr
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +00007562 %iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007563
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007564Vector of pointers:
7565"""""""""""""""""""
7566
7567The ``getelementptr`` returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
7568when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
7569arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
7570will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007571
7572.. code-block:: llvm
7573
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007574 ; All arguments are vectors:
7575 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
7576 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007577
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007578 ; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
7579 ; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
7580 %A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007581
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007582 ; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
7583 ; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
7584 %A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007585
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007586 ; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
7587
7588The two following instructions are equivalent:
7589
7590.. code-block:: llvm
7591
7592 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
7593 <4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
7594 <4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
7595 <4 x i32> %ind4,
7596 <4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
Sean Silva706fba52015-08-06 22:56:24 +00007597
Elena Demikhovsky37a4da82015-07-09 07:42:48 +00007598 getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
7599 i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
7600
7601Let's look at the C code, where the vector version of ``getelementptr``
7602makes sense:
7603
7604.. code-block:: c
7605
7606 // Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
7607 double *A, B; int *C;
7608 for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
7609 A[i] = B[C[i]];
7610 }
7611
7612.. code-block:: llvm
7613
7614 ; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
7615 %ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
7616 ; load 8 elements from array B into A
7617 %A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
7618 i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007619
7620Conversion Operations
7621---------------------
7622
7623The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions
7624(casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform
7625various bit conversions on the operand.
7626
7627'``trunc .. to``' Instruction
7628^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7629
7630Syntax:
7631"""""""
7632
7633::
7634
7635 <result> = trunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7636
7637Overview:
7638"""""""""
7639
7640The '``trunc``' instruction truncates its operand to the type ``ty2``.
7641
7642Arguments:
7643""""""""""
7644
7645The '``trunc``' instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
7646it to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors
7647of the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7648larger than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``. Equal sized
7649types are not allowed.
7650
7651Semantics:
7652""""""""""
7653
7654The '``trunc``' instruction truncates the high order bits in ``value``
7655and converts the remaining bits to ``ty2``. Since the source size must
7656be larger than the destination size, ``trunc`` cannot be a *no-op cast*.
7657It will always truncate bits.
7658
7659Example:
7660""""""""
7661
7662.. code-block:: llvm
7663
7664 %X = trunc i32 257 to i8 ; yields i8:1
7665 %Y = trunc i32 123 to i1 ; yields i1:true
7666 %Z = trunc i32 122 to i1 ; yields i1:false
7667 %W = trunc <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i8> ; yields <i8 8, i8 7>
7668
7669'``zext .. to``' Instruction
7670^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7671
7672Syntax:
7673"""""""
7674
7675::
7676
7677 <result> = zext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7678
7679Overview:
7680"""""""""
7681
7682The '``zext``' instruction zero extends its operand to type ``ty2``.
7683
7684Arguments:
7685""""""""""
7686
7687The '``zext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
7688to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
7689the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7690smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7691
7692Semantics:
7693""""""""""
7694
7695The ``zext`` fills the high order bits of the ``value`` with zero bits
7696until it reaches the size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7697
7698When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
7699
7700Example:
7701""""""""
7702
7703.. code-block:: llvm
7704
7705 %X = zext i32 257 to i64 ; yields i64:257
7706 %Y = zext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:1
7707 %Z = zext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
7708
7709'``sext .. to``' Instruction
7710^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7711
7712Syntax:
7713"""""""
7714
7715::
7716
7717 <result> = sext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7718
7719Overview:
7720"""""""""
7721
7722The '``sext``' sign extends ``value`` to the type ``ty2``.
7723
7724Arguments:
7725""""""""""
7726
7727The '``sext``' instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
7728to. Both types must be of :ref:`integer <t_integer>` types, or vectors of
7729the same number of integers. The bit size of the ``value`` must be
7730smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ``ty2``.
7731
7732Semantics:
7733""""""""""
7734
7735The '``sext``' instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
7736bit (highest order bit) of the ``value`` until it reaches the bit size
7737of the type ``ty2``.
7738
7739When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
7740
7741Example:
7742""""""""
7743
7744.. code-block:: llvm
7745
7746 %X = sext i8 -1 to i16 ; yields i16 :65535
7747 %Y = sext i1 true to i32 ; yields i32:-1
7748 %Z = sext <2 x i16> <i16 8, i16 7> to <2 x i32> ; yields <i32 8, i32 7>
7749
7750'``fptrunc .. to``' Instruction
7751^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7752
7753Syntax:
7754"""""""
7755
7756::
7757
7758 <result> = fptrunc <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7759
7760Overview:
7761"""""""""
7762
7763The '``fptrunc``' instruction truncates ``value`` to type ``ty2``.
7764
7765Arguments:
7766""""""""""
7767
7768The '``fptrunc``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7769value to cast and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it to.
7770The size of ``value`` must be larger than the size of ``ty2``. This
7771implies that ``fptrunc`` cannot be used to make a *no-op cast*.
7772
7773Semantics:
7774""""""""""
7775
Dan Liew50456fb2015-09-03 18:43:56 +00007776The '``fptrunc``' instruction casts a ``value`` from a larger
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007777:ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a smaller :ref:`floating
Dan Liew50456fb2015-09-03 18:43:56 +00007778point <t_floating>` type. If the value cannot fit (i.e. overflows) within the
7779destination type, ``ty2``, then the results are undefined. If the cast produces
7780an inexact result, how rounding is performed (e.g. truncation, also known as
7781round to zero) is undefined.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00007782
7783Example:
7784""""""""
7785
7786.. code-block:: llvm
7787
7788 %X = fptrunc double 123.0 to float ; yields float:123.0
7789 %Y = fptrunc double 1.0E+300 to float ; yields undefined
7790
7791'``fpext .. to``' Instruction
7792^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7793
7794Syntax:
7795"""""""
7796
7797::
7798
7799 <result> = fpext <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7800
7801Overview:
7802"""""""""
7803
7804The '``fpext``' extends a floating point ``value`` to a larger floating
7805point value.
7806
7807Arguments:
7808""""""""""
7809
7810The '``fpext``' instruction takes a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7811``value`` to cast, and a :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to cast it
7812to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
7813
7814Semantics:
7815""""""""""
7816
7817The '``fpext``' instruction extends the ``value`` from a smaller
7818:ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type to a larger :ref:`floating
7819point <t_floating>` type. The ``fpext`` cannot be used to make a
7820*no-op cast* because it always changes bits. Use ``bitcast`` to make a
7821*no-op cast* for a floating point cast.
7822
7823Example:
7824""""""""
7825
7826.. code-block:: llvm
7827
7828 %X = fpext float 3.125 to double ; yields double:3.125000e+00
7829 %Y = fpext double %X to fp128 ; yields fp128:0xL00000000000000004000900000000000
7830
7831'``fptoui .. to``' Instruction
7832^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7833
7834Syntax:
7835"""""""
7836
7837::
7838
7839 <result> = fptoui <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7840
7841Overview:
7842"""""""""
7843
7844The '``fptoui``' converts a floating point ``value`` to its unsigned
7845integer equivalent of type ``ty2``.
7846
7847Arguments:
7848""""""""""
7849
7850The '``fptoui``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7851scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
7852cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
7853``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
7854type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7855
7856Semantics:
7857""""""""""
7858
7859The '``fptoui``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
7860point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
7861unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
7862are undefined.
7863
7864Example:
7865""""""""
7866
7867.. code-block:: llvm
7868
7869 %X = fptoui double 123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:123
7870 %Y = fptoui float 1.0E+300 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
7871 %Z = fptoui float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
7872
7873'``fptosi .. to``' Instruction
7874^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7875
7876Syntax:
7877"""""""
7878
7879::
7880
7881 <result> = fptosi <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7882
7883Overview:
7884"""""""""
7885
7886The '``fptosi``' instruction converts :ref:`floating point <t_floating>`
7887``value`` to type ``ty2``.
7888
7889Arguments:
7890""""""""""
7891
7892The '``fptosi``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7893scalar or vector :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` value, and a type to
7894cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` type. If
7895``ty`` is a vector floating point type, ``ty2`` must be a vector integer
7896type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7897
7898Semantics:
7899""""""""""
7900
7901The '``fptosi``' instruction converts its :ref:`floating
7902point <t_floating>` operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
7903signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ``ty2``, the results
7904are undefined.
7905
7906Example:
7907""""""""
7908
7909.. code-block:: llvm
7910
7911 %X = fptosi double -123.0 to i32 ; yields i32:-123
7912 %Y = fptosi float 1.0E-247 to i1 ; yields undefined:1
7913 %Z = fptosi float 1.04E+17 to i8 ; yields undefined:1
7914
7915'``uitofp .. to``' Instruction
7916^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7917
7918Syntax:
7919"""""""
7920
7921::
7922
7923 <result> = uitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7924
7925Overview:
7926"""""""""
7927
7928The '``uitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as an unsigned integer
7929and converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
7930
7931Arguments:
7932""""""""""
7933
7934The '``uitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7935scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
7936``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
7937``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
7938type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7939
7940Semantics:
7941""""""""""
7942
7943The '``uitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
7944integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point
7945value. If the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results
7946are undefined.
7947
7948Example:
7949""""""""
7950
7951.. code-block:: llvm
7952
7953 %X = uitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
7954 %Y = uitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:255.0
7955
7956'``sitofp .. to``' Instruction
7957^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
7958
7959Syntax:
7960"""""""
7961
7962::
7963
7964 <result> = sitofp <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
7965
7966Overview:
7967"""""""""
7968
7969The '``sitofp``' instruction regards ``value`` as a signed integer and
7970converts that value to the ``ty2`` type.
7971
7972Arguments:
7973""""""""""
7974
7975The '``sitofp``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
7976scalar or vector :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value, and a type to cast it to
7977``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`floating point <t_floating>` type. If
7978``ty`` is a vector integer type, ``ty2`` must be a vector floating point
7979type with the same number of elements as ``ty``
7980
7981Semantics:
7982""""""""""
7983
7984The '``sitofp``' instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
7985quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point value. If
7986the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are
7987undefined.
7988
7989Example:
7990""""""""
7991
7992.. code-block:: llvm
7993
7994 %X = sitofp i32 257 to float ; yields float:257.0
7995 %Y = sitofp i8 -1 to double ; yields double:-1.0
7996
7997.. _i_ptrtoint:
7998
7999'``ptrtoint .. to``' Instruction
8000^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8001
8002Syntax:
8003"""""""
8004
8005::
8006
8007 <result> = ptrtoint <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8008
8009Overview:
8010"""""""""
8011
8012The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
8013pointers ``value`` to the integer (or vector of integers) type ``ty2``.
8014
8015Arguments:
8016""""""""""
8017
8018The '``ptrtoint``' instruction takes a ``value`` to cast, which must be
Ed Maste8ed40ce2015-04-14 20:52:58 +00008019a value of type :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or a vector of pointers, and a
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008020type to cast it to ``ty2``, which must be an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
8021a vector of integers type.
8022
8023Semantics:
8024""""""""""
8025
8026The '``ptrtoint``' instruction converts ``value`` to integer type
8027``ty2`` by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
8028truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
8029If ``value`` is smaller than ``ty2`` then a zero extension is done. If
8030``value`` is larger than ``ty2`` then a truncation is done. If they are
8031the same size, then nothing is done (*no-op cast*) other than a type
8032change.
8033
8034Example:
8035""""""""
8036
8037.. code-block:: llvm
8038
8039 %X = ptrtoint i32* %P to i8 ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
8040 %Y = ptrtoint i32* %P to i64 ; yields zero extension on 32-bit architecture
8041 %Z = ptrtoint <4 x i32*> %P to <4 x i64>; yields vector zero extension for a vector of addresses on 32-bit architecture
8042
8043.. _i_inttoptr:
8044
8045'``inttoptr .. to``' Instruction
8046^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8047
8048Syntax:
8049"""""""
8050
8051::
8052
8053 <result> = inttoptr <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8054
8055Overview:
8056"""""""""
8057
8058The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts an integer ``value`` to a
8059pointer type, ``ty2``.
8060
8061Arguments:
8062""""""""""
8063
8064The '``inttoptr``' instruction takes an :ref:`integer <t_integer>` value to
8065cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>`
8066type.
8067
8068Semantics:
8069""""""""""
8070
8071The '``inttoptr``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` by
8072applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
8073of the integer ``value``. If ``value`` is larger than the size of a
8074pointer then a truncation is done. If ``value`` is smaller than the size
8075of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
8076nothing is done (*no-op cast*).
8077
8078Example:
8079""""""""
8080
8081.. code-block:: llvm
8082
8083 %X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
8084 %Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
8085 %Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
8086 %Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
8087
8088.. _i_bitcast:
8089
8090'``bitcast .. to``' Instruction
8091^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8092
8093Syntax:
8094"""""""
8095
8096::
8097
8098 <result> = bitcast <ty> <value> to <ty2> ; yields ty2
8099
8100Overview:
8101"""""""""
8102
8103The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2`` without
8104changing any bits.
8105
8106Arguments:
8107""""""""""
8108
8109The '``bitcast``' instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
8110non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00008111also be a non-aggregate :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. The
8112bit sizes of ``value`` and the destination type, ``ty2``, must be
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008113identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00008114also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
8115conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
8116long as they have the same size).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008117
8118Semantics:
8119""""""""""
8120
Matt Arsenault24b49c42013-07-31 17:49:08 +00008121The '``bitcast``' instruction converts ``value`` to type ``ty2``. It
8122is always a *no-op cast* because no bits change with this
8123conversion. The conversion is done as if the ``value`` had been stored
8124to memory and read back as type ``ty2``. Pointer (or vector of
8125pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008126pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
8127To convert pointers to other types, use the :ref:`inttoptr <i_inttoptr>`
8128or :ref:`ptrtoint <i_ptrtoint>` instructions first.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008129
8130Example:
8131""""""""
8132
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008133.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008134
8135 %X = bitcast i8 255 to i8 ; yields i8 :-1
8136 %Y = bitcast i32* %x to sint* ; yields sint*:%x
8137 %Z = bitcast <2 x int> %V to i64; ; yields i64: %V
8138 %Z = bitcast <2 x i32*> %V to <2 x i64*> ; yields <2 x i64*>
8139
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008140.. _i_addrspacecast:
8141
8142'``addrspacecast .. to``' Instruction
8143^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8144
8145Syntax:
8146"""""""
8147
8148::
8149
8150 <result> = addrspacecast <pty> <ptrval> to <pty2> ; yields pty2
8151
8152Overview:
8153"""""""""
8154
8155The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts ``ptrval`` from ``pty`` in
8156address space ``n`` to type ``pty2`` in address space ``m``.
8157
8158Arguments:
8159""""""""""
8160
8161The '``addrspacecast``' instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
8162to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
8163address space.
8164
8165Semantics:
8166""""""""""
8167
8168The '``addrspacecast``' instruction converts the pointer value
8169``ptrval`` to type ``pty2``. It can be a *no-op cast* or a complex
Matt Arsenault54a2a172013-11-15 05:44:56 +00008170value modification, depending on the target and the address space
8171pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
8172performed with the ``bitcast`` instruction. Note that if the address space
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008173conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
8174location.
8175
8176Example:
8177""""""""
8178
8179.. code-block:: llvm
8180
Matt Arsenault9c13dd02013-11-15 22:43:50 +00008181 %X = addrspacecast i32* %x to i32 addrspace(1)* ; yields i32 addrspace(1)*:%x
8182 %Y = addrspacecast i32 addrspace(1)* %y to i64 addrspace(2)* ; yields i64 addrspace(2)*:%y
8183 %Z = addrspacecast <4 x i32*> %z to <4 x float addrspace(3)*> ; yields <4 x float addrspace(3)*>:%z
Matt Arsenaultb03bd4d2013-11-15 01:34:59 +00008184
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008185.. _otherops:
8186
8187Other Operations
8188----------------
8189
8190The instructions in this category are the "miscellaneous" instructions,
8191which defy better classification.
8192
8193.. _i_icmp:
8194
8195'``icmp``' Instruction
8196^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8197
8198Syntax:
8199"""""""
8200
8201::
8202
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00008203 <result> = icmp <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008204
8205Overview:
8206"""""""""
8207
8208The '``icmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
8209boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
8210pointer, or pointer vector operands.
8211
8212Arguments:
8213""""""""""
8214
8215The '``icmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
8216the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
Sanjay Patel43d41442016-03-30 21:38:20 +00008217not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008218
8219#. ``eq``: equal
8220#. ``ne``: not equal
8221#. ``ugt``: unsigned greater than
8222#. ``uge``: unsigned greater or equal
8223#. ``ult``: unsigned less than
8224#. ``ule``: unsigned less or equal
8225#. ``sgt``: signed greater than
8226#. ``sge``: signed greater or equal
8227#. ``slt``: signed less than
8228#. ``sle``: signed less or equal
8229
8230The remaining two arguments must be :ref:`integer <t_integer>` or
8231:ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` or integer :ref:`vector <t_vector>` typed. They
8232must also be identical types.
8233
8234Semantics:
8235""""""""""
8236
8237The '``icmp``' compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the condition
8238code given as ``cond``. The comparison performed always yields either an
8239:ref:`i1 <t_integer>` or vector of ``i1`` result, as follows:
8240
8241#. ``eq``: yields ``true`` if the operands are equal, ``false``
8242 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
8243#. ``ne``: yields ``true`` if the operands are unequal, ``false``
8244 otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.
8245#. ``ugt``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8246 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
8247#. ``uge``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8248 ``true`` if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8249#. ``ult``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8250 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
8251#. ``ule``: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yields
8252 ``true`` if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8253#. ``sgt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8254 if ``op1`` is greater than ``op2``.
8255#. ``sge``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8256 if ``op1`` is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8257#. ``slt``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8258 if ``op1`` is less than ``op2``.
8259#. ``sle``: interprets the operands as signed values and yields ``true``
8260 if ``op1`` is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8261
8262If the operands are :ref:`pointer <t_pointer>` typed, the pointer values
8263are compared as if they were integers.
8264
8265If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
8266element. The result is an ``i1`` vector with the same number of elements
8267as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an ``i1``.
8268
8269Example:
8270""""""""
8271
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008272.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008273
8274 <result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8275 <result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
8276 <result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
8277 <result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8278 <result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8279 <result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
8280
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008281.. _i_fcmp:
8282
8283'``fcmp``' Instruction
8284^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8285
8286Syntax:
8287"""""""
8288
8289::
8290
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00008291 <result> = fcmp [fast-math flags]* <cond> <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields i1 or <N x i1>:result
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008292
8293Overview:
8294"""""""""
8295
8296The '``fcmp``' instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
8297values based on comparison of its operands.
8298
8299If the operands are floating point scalars, then the result type is a
8300boolean (:ref:`i1 <t_integer>`).
8301
8302If the operands are floating point vectors, then the result type is a
8303vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being
8304compared.
8305
8306Arguments:
8307""""""""""
8308
8309The '``fcmp``' instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
8310the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
Sanjay Patel43d41442016-03-30 21:38:20 +00008311not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008312
8313#. ``false``: no comparison, always returns false
8314#. ``oeq``: ordered and equal
8315#. ``ogt``: ordered and greater than
8316#. ``oge``: ordered and greater than or equal
8317#. ``olt``: ordered and less than
8318#. ``ole``: ordered and less than or equal
8319#. ``one``: ordered and not equal
8320#. ``ord``: ordered (no nans)
8321#. ``ueq``: unordered or equal
8322#. ``ugt``: unordered or greater than
8323#. ``uge``: unordered or greater than or equal
8324#. ``ult``: unordered or less than
8325#. ``ule``: unordered or less than or equal
8326#. ``une``: unordered or not equal
8327#. ``uno``: unordered (either nans)
8328#. ``true``: no comparison, always returns true
8329
8330*Ordered* means that neither operand is a QNAN while *unordered* means
8331that either operand may be a QNAN.
8332
8333Each of ``val1`` and ``val2`` arguments must be either a :ref:`floating
8334point <t_floating>` type or a :ref:`vector <t_vector>` of floating point
8335type. They must have identical types.
8336
8337Semantics:
8338""""""""""
8339
8340The '``fcmp``' instruction compares ``op1`` and ``op2`` according to the
8341condition code given as ``cond``. If the operands are vectors, then the
8342vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
8343always yields an :ref:`i1 <t_integer>` result, as follows:
8344
8345#. ``false``: always yields ``false``, regardless of operands.
8346#. ``oeq``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8347 is equal to ``op2``.
8348#. ``ogt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8349 is greater than ``op2``.
8350#. ``oge``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8351 is greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8352#. ``olt``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8353 is less than ``op2``.
8354#. ``ole``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8355 is less than or equal to ``op2``.
8356#. ``one``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN and ``op1``
8357 is not equal to ``op2``.
8358#. ``ord``: yields ``true`` if both operands are not a QNAN.
8359#. ``ueq``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8360 equal to ``op2``.
8361#. ``ugt``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8362 greater than ``op2``.
8363#. ``uge``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8364 greater than or equal to ``op2``.
8365#. ``ult``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8366 less than ``op2``.
8367#. ``ule``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8368 less than or equal to ``op2``.
8369#. ``une``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN or ``op1`` is
8370 not equal to ``op2``.
8371#. ``uno``: yields ``true`` if either operand is a QNAN.
8372#. ``true``: always yields ``true``, regardless of operands.
8373
James Molloy88eb5352015-07-10 12:52:00 +00008374The ``fcmp`` instruction can also optionally take any number of
8375:ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
8376otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations.
8377
8378Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an ``fcmp`` instruction, but the
8379only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
8380assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
8381``nnan``, ``ninf``, and ``nsz``. See :ref:`fastmath` for more information.
8382
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008383Example:
8384""""""""
8385
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008386.. code-block:: text
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008387
8388 <result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
8389 <result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
8390 <result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
8391 <result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
8392
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008393.. _i_phi:
8394
8395'``phi``' Instruction
8396^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8397
8398Syntax:
8399"""""""
8400
8401::
8402
8403 <result> = phi <ty> [ <val0>, <label0>], ...
8404
8405Overview:
8406"""""""""
8407
8408The '``phi``' instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
8409graph representing the function.
8410
8411Arguments:
8412""""""""""
8413
8414The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
8415After this, the '``phi``' instruction takes a list of pairs as
8416arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
8417block. Only values of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type may be used as
8418the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
8419label arguments.
8420
8421There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block
8422and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic
8423block.
8424
8425For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
8426deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
8427the current block (but after any definition of an '``invoke``'
8428instruction's return value on the same edge).
8429
8430Semantics:
8431""""""""""
8432
8433At runtime, the '``phi``' instruction logically takes on the value
8434specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
8435executed just prior to the current block.
8436
8437Example:
8438""""""""
8439
8440.. code-block:: llvm
8441
8442 Loop: ; Infinite loop that counts from 0 on up...
8443 %indvar = phi i32 [ 0, %LoopHeader ], [ %nextindvar, %Loop ]
8444 %nextindvar = add i32 %indvar, 1
8445 br label %Loop
8446
8447.. _i_select:
8448
8449'``select``' Instruction
8450^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8451
8452Syntax:
8453"""""""
8454
8455::
8456
8457 <result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
8458
8459 selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
8460
8461Overview:
8462"""""""""
8463
8464The '``select``' instruction is used to choose one value based on a
Joerg Sonnenberger94321ec2014-03-26 15:30:21 +00008465condition, without IR-level branching.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008466
8467Arguments:
8468""""""""""
8469
8470The '``select``' instruction requires an 'i1' value or a vector of 'i1'
8471values indicating the condition, and two values of the same :ref:`first
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00008472class <t_firstclass>` type.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008473
8474Semantics:
8475""""""""""
8476
8477If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns
8478the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value
8479argument.
8480
8481If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be
8482vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
8483
David Majnemer40a0b592015-03-03 22:45:47 +00008484If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the
8485same size, then an entire vector is selected.
8486
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008487Example:
8488""""""""
8489
8490.. code-block:: llvm
8491
8492 %X = select i1 true, i8 17, i8 42 ; yields i8:17
8493
8494.. _i_call:
8495
8496'``call``' Instruction
8497^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8498
8499Syntax:
8500"""""""
8501
8502::
8503
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00008504 <result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty>|<fnty> <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00008505 [ operand bundles ]
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008506
8507Overview:
8508"""""""""
8509
8510The '``call``' instruction represents a simple function call.
8511
8512Arguments:
8513""""""""""
8514
8515This instruction requires several arguments:
8516
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008517#. The optional ``tail`` and ``musttail`` markers indicate that the optimizers
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008518 should perform tail call optimization. The ``tail`` marker is a hint that
8519 `can be ignored <CodeGenerator.html#sibcallopt>`_. The ``musttail`` marker
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008520 means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008521 be correct. The ``musttail`` marker provides these guarantees:
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008522
8523 #. The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a
8524 recursive cycle in the call graph.
8525 #. Arguments with the :ref:`inalloca <attr_inalloca>` attribute are
8526 forwarded in place.
8527
8528 Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas or varargs from
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008529 the caller. Calls marked ``musttail`` must obey the following additional
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008530 rules:
8531
8532 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction,
8533 or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
8534 - The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value
8535 produced by the call or void.
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00008536 - The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008537 parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not
8538 in address space.
8539 - The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
8540 - All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg,
8541 returned, and inalloca, must match.
Reid Kleckner83498642014-08-26 00:33:28 +00008542 - The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a
8543 non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so
8544 long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
Reid Kleckner5772b772014-04-24 20:14:34 +00008545
8546 Tail call optimization for calls marked ``tail`` is guaranteed to occur if
8547 the following conditions are met:
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008548
8549 - Caller and callee both have the calling convention ``fastcc``.
8550 - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret
8551 uses value of call or is void).
8552 - Option ``-tailcallopt`` is enabled, or
8553 ``llvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt`` is ``true``.
Alp Tokercf218752014-06-30 18:57:16 +00008554 - `Platform-specific constraints are
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008555 met. <CodeGenerator.html#tailcallopt>`_
8556
Akira Hatanaka5cfcce122015-11-06 23:55:38 +00008557#. The optional ``notail`` marker indicates that the optimizers should not add
8558 ``tail`` or ``musttail`` markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail
8559 call optimization from being performed on the call.
8560
Sanjay Patelfa54ace2015-12-14 21:59:03 +00008561#. The optional ``fast-math flags`` marker indicates that the call has one or more
8562 :ref:`fast-math flags <fastmath>`, which are optimization hints to enable
8563 otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid
8564 for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.
8565
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008566#. The optional "cconv" marker indicates which :ref:`calling
8567 convention <callingconv>` the call should use. If none is
8568 specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The
8569 calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of
8570 the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
8571#. The optional :ref:`Parameter Attributes <paramattrs>` list for return
8572 values. Only '``zeroext``', '``signext``', and '``inreg``' attributes
8573 are valid here.
8574#. '``ty``': the type of the call instruction itself which is also the
8575 type of the return value. Functions that return no value are marked
8576 ``void``.
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00008577#. '``fnty``': shall be the signature of the function being called. The
8578 argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This
8579 type can be omitted if the function is not varargs.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008580#. '``fnptrval``': An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to
David Blaikieb83cf102016-07-13 17:21:34 +00008581 be called. In most cases, this is a direct function call, but
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008582 indirect ``call``'s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer
8583 to function value.
8584#. '``function args``': argument list whose types match the function
8585 signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must
8586 be of :ref:`first class <t_firstclass>` type. If the function signature
8587 indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the
8588 extra arguments can be specified.
8589#. The optional :ref:`function attributes <fnattrs>` list. Only
Matt Arsenault50d02ef2016-06-10 00:36:57 +00008590 '``noreturn``', '``nounwind``', '``readonly``' , '``readnone``',
8591 and '``convergent``' attributes are valid here.
Sanjoy Dasb513a9f2015-09-24 23:34:52 +00008592#. The optional :ref:`operand bundles <opbundles>` list.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008593
8594Semantics:
8595""""""""""
8596
8597The '``call``' instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
8598a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
8599values. Upon a '``ret``' instruction in the called function, control
8600flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
8601return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
8602
8603Example:
8604""""""""
8605
8606.. code-block:: llvm
8607
8608 %retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
8609 call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
8610 %X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
8611 %Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
8612 call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
8613
8614 %struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +00008615 %r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008616 %gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
8617 %gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
8618 %Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
8619 %ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
8620
8621llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match
8622the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may
8623perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption.
8624This is something we'd like to change in the future to provide better
8625support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
8626
8627.. _i_va_arg:
8628
8629'``va_arg``' Instruction
8630^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8631
8632Syntax:
8633"""""""
8634
8635::
8636
8637 <resultval> = va_arg <va_list*> <arglist>, <argty>
8638
8639Overview:
8640"""""""""
8641
8642The '``va_arg``' instruction is used to access arguments passed through
8643the "variable argument" area of a function call. It is used to implement
8644the ``va_arg`` macro in C.
8645
8646Arguments:
8647""""""""""
8648
8649This instruction takes a ``va_list*`` value and the type of the
8650argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
8651increments the ``va_list`` to point to the next argument. The actual
8652type of ``va_list`` is target specific.
8653
8654Semantics:
8655""""""""""
8656
8657The '``va_arg``' instruction loads an argument of the specified type
8658from the specified ``va_list`` and causes the ``va_list`` to point to
8659the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
8660handling :ref:`Intrinsic Functions <int_varargs>`.
8661
8662It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
8663not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the ``vfprintf``
8664function.
8665
8666``va_arg`` is an LLVM instruction instead of an :ref:`intrinsic
8667function <intrinsics>` because it takes a type as an argument.
8668
8669Example:
8670""""""""
8671
8672See the :ref:`variable argument processing <int_varargs>` section.
8673
8674Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va\_arg on many
8675targets. Also, it does not currently support va\_arg with aggregate
8676types on any target.
8677
8678.. _i_landingpad:
8679
8680'``landingpad``' Instruction
8681^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8682
8683Syntax:
8684"""""""
8685
8686::
8687
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008688 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
8689 <resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008690
8691 <clause> := catch <type> <value>
8692 <clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
8693
8694Overview:
8695"""""""""
8696
8697The '``landingpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
8698system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00008699is a landing pad --- one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008700code found in the ``catch`` portion of a ``try``/``catch`` sequence. It
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008701defines values supplied by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008702re-entry to the function. The ``resultval`` has the type ``resultty``.
8703
8704Arguments:
8705""""""""""
8706
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008707The optional
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008708``cleanup`` flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
8709
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +00008710A ``clause`` begins with the clause type --- ``catch`` or ``filter`` --- and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008711contains the global variable representing the "type" that may be caught
8712or filtered respectively. Unlike the ``catch`` clause, the ``filter``
8713clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
8714"``[0 x i8**] undef``" for a filter which cannot throw. The
8715'``landingpad``' instruction must contain *at least* one ``clause`` or
8716the ``cleanup`` flag.
8717
8718Semantics:
8719""""""""""
8720
8721The '``landingpad``' instruction defines the values which are set by the
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008722:ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` upon re-entry to the function, and
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008723therefore the "result type" of the ``landingpad`` instruction. As with
8724calling conventions, how the personality function results are
8725represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
8726
8727The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
8728``landingpad`` instructions are merged together through inlining, the
8729clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
8730When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
8731the exception is compared against each ``clause`` in turn. If it doesn't
8732match any of the clauses, and the ``cleanup`` flag is not set, then
8733unwinding continues further up the call stack.
8734
8735The ``landingpad`` instruction has several restrictions:
8736
8737- A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
8738 of an '``invoke``' instruction.
8739- A landing pad block must have a '``landingpad``' instruction as its
8740 first non-PHI instruction.
8741- There can be only one '``landingpad``' instruction within the landing
8742 pad block.
8743- A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
8744 '``landingpad``' instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008745
8746Example:
8747""""""""
8748
8749.. code-block:: llvm
8750
8751 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008752 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008753 catch i8** @_ZTIi
8754 ;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008755 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008756 cleanup
8757 ;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
David Majnemer7fddecc2015-06-17 20:52:32 +00008758 %res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008759 catch i8** @_ZTIi
8760 filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
8761
Joseph Tremoulet2adaa982016-01-10 04:46:10 +00008762.. _i_catchpad:
8763
8764'``catchpad``' Instruction
8765^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8766
8767Syntax:
8768"""""""
8769
8770::
8771
8772 <resultval> = catchpad within <catchswitch> [<args>*]
8773
8774Overview:
8775"""""""""
8776
8777The '``catchpad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
8778system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
8779begins a catch handler --- one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
8780control to catch an exception.
8781
8782Arguments:
8783""""""""""
8784
8785The ``catchswitch`` operand must always be a token produced by a
8786:ref:`catchswitch <i_catchswitch>` instruction in a predecessor block. This
8787ensures that each ``catchpad`` has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
8788terminates in a ``catchswitch``.
8789
8790The ``args`` correspond to whatever information the personality routine
8791requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
8792will transfer to the ``catchpad`` if this is the first appropriate handler for
8793the exception.
8794
8795The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to match the
8796``catchpad`` to corresponding :ref:`catchrets <i_catchret>` and other nested EH
8797pads.
8798
8799Semantics:
8800""""""""""
8801
8802When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
8803exception is compared against the ``args``. If it doesn't match, control will
8804not reach the ``catchpad`` instruction. The representation of ``args`` is
8805entirely target and personality function-specific.
8806
8807Like the :ref:`landingpad <i_landingpad>` instruction, the ``catchpad``
8808instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
8809
8810The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by ``catchpad`` and other "pad"
8811instructions is described in the
8812`Windows exception handling documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh>`_.
8813
8814When a ``catchpad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
8815described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
8816it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
8817that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
8818
8819Example:
8820""""""""
8821
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008822.. code-block:: text
Joseph Tremoulet2adaa982016-01-10 04:46:10 +00008823
8824 dispatch:
8825 %cs = catchswitch within none [label %handler0] unwind to caller
8826 ;; A catch block which can catch an integer.
8827 handler0:
8828 %tok = catchpad within %cs [i8** @_ZTIi]
8829
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008830.. _i_cleanuppad:
8831
8832'``cleanuppad``' Instruction
8833^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8834
8835Syntax:
8836"""""""
8837
8838::
8839
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008840 <resultval> = cleanuppad within <parent> [<args>*]
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008841
8842Overview:
8843"""""""""
8844
8845The '``cleanuppad``' instruction is used by `LLVM's exception handling
8846system <ExceptionHandling.html#overview>`_ to specify that a basic block
8847is a cleanup block --- one where a personality routine attempts to
8848transfer control to run cleanup actions.
8849The ``args`` correspond to whatever additional
8850information the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` requires to
8851execute the cleanup.
Joseph Tremoulet8220bcc2015-08-23 00:26:33 +00008852The ``resultval`` has the type :ref:`token <t_token>` and is used to
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008853match the ``cleanuppad`` to corresponding :ref:`cleanuprets <i_cleanupret>`.
8854The ``parent`` argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
8855``cleanuppad`` instruction. If the ``cleanuppad`` is not inside a funclet,
8856this operand may be the token ``none``.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008857
8858Arguments:
8859""""""""""
8860
8861The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted
8862by the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>`.
8863
8864Semantics:
8865""""""""""
8866
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008867When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
8868the :ref:`personality function <personalityfn>` transfers control to the
8869``cleanuppad`` with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
Joseph Tremoulet9ce71f72015-09-03 09:09:43 +00008870As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
8871represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008872
8873The ``cleanuppad`` instruction has several restrictions:
8874
8875- A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of
8876 an exceptional instruction.
8877- A cleanup block must have a '``cleanuppad``' instruction as its
8878 first non-PHI instruction.
8879- There can be only one '``cleanuppad``' instruction within the
8880 cleanup block.
8881- A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
8882 '``cleanuppad``' instruction.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008883
Joseph Tremoulete28885e2016-01-10 04:28:38 +00008884When a ``cleanuppad`` has been "entered" but not yet "exited" (as
8885described in the `EH documentation\ <ExceptionHandling.html#wineh-constraints>`_),
8886it is undefined behavior to execute a :ref:`call <i_call>` or :ref:`invoke <i_invoke>`
8887that does not carry an appropriate :ref:`"funclet" bundle <ob_funclet>`.
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008888
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008889Example:
8890""""""""
8891
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +00008892.. code-block:: text
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008893
David Majnemer8a1c45d2015-12-12 05:38:55 +00008894 %tok = cleanuppad within %cs []
David Majnemer654e1302015-07-31 17:58:14 +00008895
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008896.. _intrinsics:
8897
8898Intrinsic Functions
8899===================
8900
8901LLVM supports the notion of an "intrinsic function". These functions
8902have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain
8903restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism
8904for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the
8905transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode
8906reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
8907
8908Intrinsic function names must all start with an "``llvm.``" prefix. This
8909prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
8910not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
8911functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
8912functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
8913to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
8914intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
8915are added that they be documented here.
8916
8917Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic
8918represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on
8919different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million
8920different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an
8921intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the
8922argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any
8923integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a
8924previous argument's type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic
8925function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be
8926of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single
8927argument or the result.
8928
8929Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
8930types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
8931those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
8932whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
8933``llvm.ctpop`` function can take an integer of any width and returns an
8934integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
8935functions such as ``i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)`` and
8936``i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)``. Only one type, the return type, is
8937overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument's
8938type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
8939name suffix.
8940
8941To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the `Extending
8942LLVM Guide <ExtendingLLVM.html>`_.
8943
8944.. _int_varargs:
8945
8946Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
8947-------------------------------------
8948
8949Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
8950:ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and these three intrinsic
8951functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
8952defined in the ``<stdarg.h>`` header file.
8953
8954All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
8955value type "``va_list``". The LLVM assembly language reference manual
8956does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
8957prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
8958
8959This example shows how the :ref:`va_arg <i_va_arg>` instruction and the
8960variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
8961
8962.. code-block:: llvm
8963
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008964 ; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
8965 ; it is merely an i8*.
8966 %struct.va_list = type { i8* }
8967
8968 ; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
8969 ; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
8970
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008971 define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
8972 ; Initialize variable argument processing
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008973 %ap = alloca %struct.va_list
8974 %ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008975 call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
8976
8977 ; Read a single integer argument
Tim Northoverab60bb92014-11-02 01:21:51 +00008978 %tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00008979
8980 ; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
8981 %aq = alloca i8*
8982 %aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
8983 call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
8984 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
8985
8986 ; Stop processing of arguments.
8987 call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
8988 ret i32 %tmp
8989 }
8990
8991 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
8992 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
8993 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
8994
8995.. _int_va_start:
8996
8997'``llvm.va_start``' Intrinsic
8998^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
8999
9000Syntax:
9001"""""""
9002
9003::
9004
Nick Lewycky04f6de02013-09-11 22:04:52 +00009005 declare void @llvm.va_start(i8* <arglist>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009006
9007Overview:
9008"""""""""
9009
9010The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic initializes ``*<arglist>`` for
9011subsequent use by ``va_arg``.
9012
9013Arguments:
9014""""""""""
9015
9016The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
9017
9018Semantics:
9019""""""""""
9020
9021The '``llvm.va_start``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_start`` macro
9022available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
9023``va_list`` element to which the argument points, so that the next call
9024to ``va_arg`` will produce the first variable argument passed to the
9025function. Unlike the C ``va_start`` macro, this intrinsic does not need
9026to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
9027that out.
9028
9029'``llvm.va_end``' Intrinsic
9030^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9031
9032Syntax:
9033"""""""
9034
9035::
9036
9037 declare void @llvm.va_end(i8* <arglist>)
9038
9039Overview:
9040"""""""""
9041
9042The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic destroys ``*<arglist>``, which has been
9043initialized previously with ``llvm.va_start`` or ``llvm.va_copy``.
9044
9045Arguments:
9046""""""""""
9047
9048The argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` to destroy.
9049
9050Semantics:
9051""""""""""
9052
9053The '``llvm.va_end``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_end`` macro
9054available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the ``va_list``
9055element to which the argument points. Calls to
9056:ref:`llvm.va_start <int_va_start>` and
9057:ref:`llvm.va_copy <int_va_copy>` must be matched exactly with calls to
9058``llvm.va_end``.
9059
9060.. _int_va_copy:
9061
9062'``llvm.va_copy``' Intrinsic
9063^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9064
9065Syntax:
9066"""""""
9067
9068::
9069
9070 declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8* <destarglist>, i8* <srcarglist>)
9071
9072Overview:
9073"""""""""
9074
9075The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic copies the current argument position
9076from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
9077
9078Arguments:
9079""""""""""
9080
9081The first argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to initialize.
9082The second argument is a pointer to a ``va_list`` element to copy from.
9083
9084Semantics:
9085""""""""""
9086
9087The '``llvm.va_copy``' intrinsic works just like the ``va_copy`` macro
9088available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
9089``va_list`` element into the destination ``va_list`` element. This
9090intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
9091arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
9092
9093Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
9094--------------------------------------
9095
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00009096LLVM's support for `Accurate Garbage Collection <GarbageCollection.html>`_
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00009097(GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic
9098calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00009099intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
9100
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009101These intrinsics allow identification of :ref:`GC roots on the
9102stack <int_gcroot>`, as well as garbage collector implementations that
9103require :ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers.
Philip Reamesc5b0f562015-02-25 23:52:06 +00009104Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009105these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00009106details, see `Garbage Collection with LLVM <GarbageCollection.html>`_.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009107
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00009108Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics
9109^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9110
9111LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009112collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00009113to the ``llvm.gcroot`` intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009114:ref:`read <int_gcread>` and :ref:`write <int_gcwrite>` barriers. The
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +00009115differences in approach are covered in the `Garbage Collection with LLVM
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +00009116<GarbageCollection.html>`_ documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
Philip Reamesf80bbff2015-02-25 23:45:20 +00009117described in :doc:`Statepoints`.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009118
9119.. _int_gcroot:
9120
9121'``llvm.gcroot``' Intrinsic
9122^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9123
9124Syntax:
9125"""""""
9126
9127::
9128
9129 declare void @llvm.gcroot(i8** %ptrloc, i8* %metadata)
9130
9131Overview:
9132"""""""""
9133
9134The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
9135the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
9136
9137Arguments:
9138""""""""""
9139
9140The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains
9141the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or
9142a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the
9143root.
9144
9145Semantics:
9146""""""""""
9147
9148At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
9149"ptrloc" location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
9150information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
9151The '``llvm.gcroot``' intrinsic may only be used in a function which
9152:ref:`specifies a GC algorithm <gc>`.
9153
9154.. _int_gcread:
9155
9156'``llvm.gcread``' Intrinsic
9157^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9158
9159Syntax:
9160"""""""
9161
9162::
9163
9164 declare i8* @llvm.gcread(i8* %ObjPtr, i8** %Ptr)
9165
9166Overview:
9167"""""""""
9168
9169The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
9170locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
9171barriers.
9172
9173Arguments:
9174""""""""""
9175
9176The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an
9177address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a
9178pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language
9179runtime (otherwise null).
9180
9181Semantics:
9182""""""""""
9183
9184The '``llvm.gcread``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
9185instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
9186the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcread``'
9187intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
9188algorithm <gc>`.
9189
9190.. _int_gcwrite:
9191
9192'``llvm.gcwrite``' Intrinsic
9193^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9194
9195Syntax:
9196"""""""
9197
9198::
9199
9200 declare void @llvm.gcwrite(i8* %P1, i8* %Obj, i8** %P2)
9201
9202Overview:
9203"""""""""
9204
9205The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
9206locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
9207barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
9208
9209Arguments:
9210""""""""""
9211
9212The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of
9213the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of
9214Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the
9215object, Obj may be null.
9216
9217Semantics:
9218""""""""""
9219
9220The '``llvm.gcwrite``' intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
9221instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
9222the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The '``llvm.gcwrite``'
9223intrinsic may only be used in a function which :ref:`specifies a GC
9224algorithm <gc>`.
9225
9226Code Generator Intrinsics
9227-------------------------
9228
9229These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that
9230may only be implemented with code generator support.
9231
9232'``llvm.returnaddress``' Intrinsic
9233^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9234
9235Syntax:
9236"""""""
9237
9238::
9239
9240 declare i8 *@llvm.returnaddress(i32 <level>)
9241
9242Overview:
9243"""""""""
9244
9245The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic attempts to compute a
9246target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
9247function or one of its callers.
9248
9249Arguments:
9250""""""""""
9251
9252The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
9253address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its
9254caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
9255value.
9256
9257Semantics:
9258""""""""""
9259
9260The '``llvm.returnaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
9261indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
9262cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
9263be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
9264used for debugging purposes.
9265
9266Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
9267other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
9268of the obvious source-language caller.
9269
9270'``llvm.frameaddress``' Intrinsic
9271^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9272
9273Syntax:
9274"""""""
9275
9276::
9277
9278 declare i8* @llvm.frameaddress(i32 <level>)
9279
9280Overview:
9281"""""""""
9282
9283The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic attempts to return the
9284target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
9285
9286Arguments:
9287""""""""""
9288
9289The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the
9290frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates
9291its caller, etc. The argument is **required** to be a constant integer
9292value.
9293
9294Semantics:
9295""""""""""
9296
9297The '``llvm.frameaddress``' intrinsic either returns a pointer
9298indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
9299cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
9300be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
9301used for debugging purposes.
9302
9303Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or
9304other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that
9305of the obvious source-language caller.
9306
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009307'``llvm.localescape``' and '``llvm.localrecover``' Intrinsics
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009308^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9309
9310Syntax:
9311"""""""
9312
9313::
9314
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009315 declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
9316 declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009317
9318Overview:
9319"""""""""
9320
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009321The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
9322allocas, and the '``llvm.localrecover``' intrinsic applies those offsets to a
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009323live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009324computed during frame layout of the caller of ``llvm.localescape``.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009325
9326Arguments:
9327""""""""""
9328
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009329All arguments to '``llvm.localescape``' must be pointers to static allocas or
9330casts of static allocas. Each function can only call '``llvm.localescape``'
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009331once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009332
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009333The ``func`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a constant
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009334bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
9335generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
9336other modules.
9337
Reid Klecknerd5afc62f2015-07-07 23:23:03 +00009338The ``fp`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' must be a frame pointer of a
9339call frame that is currently live. The return value of '``llvm.localaddress``'
9340is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
9341pointer in platform-specific ways.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009342
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009343The ``idx`` argument to '``llvm.localrecover``' indicates which alloca passed to
9344'``llvm.localescape``' to recover. It is zero-indexed.
Reid Klecknercfb9ce52015-03-05 18:26:34 +00009345
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009346Semantics:
9347""""""""""
9348
Reid Kleckner60381792015-07-07 22:25:32 +00009349These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
9350stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
9351'``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
9352child functions can use '``llvm.localrecover``' to access the escaped allocas.
9353The '``llvm.localescape``' intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
9354the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
9355'``llvm.localrecover``'.
Reid Klecknere9b89312015-01-13 00:48:10 +00009356
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00009357.. _int_read_register:
9358.. _int_write_register:
9359
9360'``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' Intrinsics
9361^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9362
9363Syntax:
9364"""""""
9365
9366::
9367
9368 declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
9369 declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
9370 declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
9371 declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithbe7ea192014-12-15 19:07:53 +00009372 !0 = !{!"sp\00"}
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00009373
9374Overview:
9375"""""""""
9376
9377The '``llvm.read_register``' and '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsics
9378provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
9379the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
9380with the register being read.
9381
9382Semantics:
9383""""""""""
9384
9385The '``llvm.read_register``' intrinsic returns the current value of the
9386register, where possible. The '``llvm.write_register``' intrinsic sets
9387the current value of the register, where possible.
9388
9389This is useful to implement named register global variables that need
9390to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on
9391bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
9392
9393The compiler doesn't check for register availability or use of the used
9394register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that,
9395allocatable registers are not supported.
9396
9397Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected
Tim Northover3b0846e2014-05-24 12:50:23 +00009398architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of
Renato Golinc7aea402014-05-06 16:51:25 +00009399work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable
9400registers.
9401
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009402.. _int_stacksave:
9403
9404'``llvm.stacksave``' Intrinsic
9405^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9406
9407Syntax:
9408"""""""
9409
9410::
9411
9412 declare i8* @llvm.stacksave()
9413
9414Overview:
9415"""""""""
9416
9417The '``llvm.stacksave``' intrinsic is used to remember the current state
9418of the function stack, for use with
9419:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. This is useful for
9420implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
9421arrays in C99.
9422
9423Semantics:
9424""""""""""
9425
9426This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
9427:ref:`llvm.stackrestore <int_stackrestore>`. When an
9428``llvm.stackrestore`` intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
9429``llvm.stacksave``, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
9430the state it was in when the ``llvm.stacksave`` intrinsic executed. In
9431practice, this pops any :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>` blocks from the stack that
9432were allocated after the ``llvm.stacksave`` was executed.
9433
9434.. _int_stackrestore:
9435
9436'``llvm.stackrestore``' Intrinsic
9437^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9438
9439Syntax:
9440"""""""
9441
9442::
9443
9444 declare void @llvm.stackrestore(i8* %ptr)
9445
9446Overview:
9447"""""""""
9448
9449The '``llvm.stackrestore``' intrinsic is used to restore the state of
9450the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
9451:ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` intrinsic executed. This is
9452useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
9453sized arrays in C99.
9454
9455Semantics:
9456""""""""""
9457
9458See the description for :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>`.
9459
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +00009460.. _int_get_dynamic_area_offset:
9461
9462'``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset``' Intrinsic
Yury Gribov81f3f152015-12-01 13:24:48 +00009463^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +00009464
9465Syntax:
9466"""""""
9467
9468::
9469
9470 declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
9471 declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
9472
9473 Overview:
9474 """""""""
9475
9476 The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
9477 get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
9478 recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
9479 intendend for use in combination with
9480 :ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
9481 pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
9482 for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
9483
9484Semantics:
9485""""""""""
9486
9487 These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to
9488 get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by :ref:`alloca <i_alloca>`
9489 on the caller's stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards,
9490 adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most
9491 recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more
Sylvestre Ledru0455cbe2016-07-28 09:28:58 +00009492 complicated, because subtracting this value from stack pointer would get the address
Yury Gribovd7dbb662015-12-01 11:40:55 +00009493 one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
9494
9495 Although for most targets `llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
9496 returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a
9497 compile-time-known constant value.
9498
9499 The return value type of :ref:`llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset>`
9500 must match the target's generic address space's (address space 0) pointer type.
9501
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009502'``llvm.prefetch``' Intrinsic
9503^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9504
9505Syntax:
9506"""""""
9507
9508::
9509
9510 declare void @llvm.prefetch(i8* <address>, i32 <rw>, i32 <locality>, i32 <cache type>)
9511
9512Overview:
9513"""""""""
9514
9515The '``llvm.prefetch``' intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
9516insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
9517Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
9518its performance characteristics.
9519
9520Arguments:
9521""""""""""
9522
9523``address`` is the address to be prefetched, ``rw`` is the specifier
9524determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
9525``locality`` is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
9526locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The ``cache type``
9527specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
9528instruction (0) cache. The ``rw``, ``locality`` and ``cache type``
9529arguments must be constant integers.
9530
9531Semantics:
9532""""""""""
9533
9534This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In
9535particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On
9536targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to
9537the processor cache for better performance.
9538
9539'``llvm.pcmarker``' Intrinsic
9540^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9541
9542Syntax:
9543"""""""
9544
9545::
9546
9547 declare void @llvm.pcmarker(i32 <id>)
9548
9549Overview:
9550"""""""""
9551
9552The '``llvm.pcmarker``' intrinsic is a method to export a Program
9553Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
9554method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
9555exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
9556guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
9557optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
9558optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
9559allow correlations of simulation runs.
9560
9561Arguments:
9562""""""""""
9563
9564``id`` is a numerical id identifying the marker.
9565
9566Semantics:
9567""""""""""
9568
9569This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends
9570that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
9571
9572'``llvm.readcyclecounter``' Intrinsic
9573^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9574
9575Syntax:
9576"""""""
9577
9578::
9579
9580 declare i64 @llvm.readcyclecounter()
9581
9582Overview:
9583"""""""""
9584
9585The '``llvm.readcyclecounter``' intrinsic provides access to the cycle
9586counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
9587targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
9588should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
9589order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
9590timings.
9591
9592Semantics:
9593""""""""""
9594
9595When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any
9596memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application
9597specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this
9598is lowered to a constant 0.
9599
Tim Northoverbc933082013-05-23 19:11:20 +00009600Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is
9601running at and the host platform.
9602
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009603'``llvm.clear_cache``' Intrinsic
9604^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9605
9606Syntax:
9607"""""""
9608
9609::
9610
9611 declare void @llvm.clear_cache(i8*, i8*)
9612
9613Overview:
9614"""""""""
9615
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009616The '``llvm.clear_cache``' intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
9617in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
9618targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
9619flushes the instruction cache.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009620
9621Semantics:
9622""""""""""
9623
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009624On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this
9625intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data
Alp Toker16f98b22014-04-09 14:47:27 +00009626cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009627instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special
9628privileges.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009629
Sean Silvad02bf3e2014-04-07 22:29:53 +00009630The default behavior is to emit a call to ``__clear_cache`` from the run
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009631time library.
Renato Golin93010e62014-03-26 14:01:32 +00009632
Joerg Sonnenberger03014d62014-03-26 14:35:21 +00009633This instrinsic does *not* empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications
9634of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
Renato Golinc0a3c1d2014-03-26 12:52:28 +00009635
Justin Bogner61ba2e32014-12-08 18:02:35 +00009636'``llvm.instrprof_increment``' Intrinsic
9637^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9638
9639Syntax:
9640"""""""
9641
9642::
9643
9644 declare void @llvm.instrprof_increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
9645 i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
9646
9647Overview:
9648"""""""""
9649
9650The '``llvm.instrprof_increment``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
9651frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
9652lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate execution counts of a
9653program at runtime.
9654
9655Arguments:
9656""""""""""
9657
9658The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
9659name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the
9660(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
9661
9662The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
9663of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
9664the third is the number of counters associated with ``name``. It is an
9665error if ``hash`` or ``num-counters`` differ between two instances of
9666``instrprof_increment`` that refer to the same name.
9667
9668The last argument refers to which of the counters for ``name`` should
9669be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and ``num-counters``.
9670
9671Semantics:
9672""""""""""
9673
9674This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
9675cause the ``-instrprof`` pass to generate the appropriate data
9676structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
9677format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
9678the ``llvm-profdata`` tool.
9679
Betul Buyukkurt6fac1742015-11-18 18:14:55 +00009680'``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' Intrinsic
9681^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9682
9683Syntax:
9684"""""""
9685
9686::
9687
9688 declare void @llvm.instrprof_value_profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
9689 i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
9690 i32 <index>)
9691
9692Overview:
9693"""""""""
9694
9695The '``llvm.instrprof_value_profile``' intrinsic can be emitted by a
9696frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
9697lowered by the ``-instrprof`` pass to find out the target values,
9698instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
9699
9700Arguments:
9701""""""""""
9702
9703The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
9704name of the entity being instrumented. ``name`` should generally be the
9705(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
9706
9707The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
9708of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
9709is an error if ``hash`` differs between two instances of
9710``llvm.instrprof_*`` that refer to the same name.
9711
9712The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
9713expression's value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
9714fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
9715supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
9716``InstrProfValueKind`` type declared in the
9717``<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>`` header file. The last argument is the
9718index of the instrumented expression within ``name``. It should be >= 0.
9719
9720Semantics:
9721""""""""""
9722
9723This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
9724should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. ``-instrprof``
9725pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
9726``llvm.instrprof_value_profile`` intrinsic with the call to the profile
9727runtime library with proper arguments.
9728
Marcin Koscielnicki3fdc2572016-04-19 20:51:05 +00009729'``llvm.thread.pointer``' Intrinsic
9730^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9731
9732Syntax:
9733"""""""
9734
9735::
9736
9737 declare i8* @llvm.thread.pointer()
9738
9739Overview:
9740"""""""""
9741
9742The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns the value of the thread
9743pointer.
9744
9745Semantics:
9746""""""""""
9747
9748The '``llvm.thread.pointer``' intrinsic returns a pointer to the TLS area
9749for the current thread. The exact semantics of this value are target
9750specific: it may point to the start of TLS area, to the end, or somewhere
9751in the middle. Depending on the target, this intrinsic may read a register,
9752call a helper function, read from an alternate memory space, or perform
9753other operations necessary to locate the TLS area. Not all targets support
9754this intrinsic.
9755
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009756Standard C Library Intrinsics
9757-----------------------------
9758
9759LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library
9760functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass
9761information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code
9762generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
9763
9764.. _int_memcpy:
9765
9766'``llvm.memcpy``' Intrinsic
9767^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9768
9769Syntax:
9770"""""""
9771
9772This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.memcpy`` on any
9773integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
9774support all bit widths however.
9775
9776::
9777
9778 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9779 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9780 declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9781 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9782
9783Overview:
9784"""""""""
9785
9786The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9787source location to the destination location.
9788
9789Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memcpy.*``
9790intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
9791arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
9792
9793Arguments:
9794""""""""""
9795
9796The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
9797pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
9798specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
9799alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
9800boolean indicating a volatile access.
9801
9802If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9803then the caller guarantees that both the source and destination pointers
9804are aligned to that boundary.
9805
9806If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memcpy`` call is
9807a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
9808very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9809
9810Semantics:
9811""""""""""
9812
9813The '``llvm.memcpy.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9814source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
9815overlap. It copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
9816to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009817argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009818
9819'``llvm.memmove``' Intrinsic
9820^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9821
9822Syntax:
9823"""""""
9824
9825This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer
9826bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all
9827bit widths however.
9828
9829::
9830
9831 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9832 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9833 declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
9834 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9835
9836Overview:
9837"""""""""
9838
9839The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics move a block of memory from the
9840source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
9841'``llvm.memcpy``' intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
9842overlap.
9843
9844Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memmove.*``
9845intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
9846arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
9847
9848Arguments:
9849""""""""""
9850
9851The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a
9852pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument
9853specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the
9854alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a
9855boolean indicating a volatile access.
9856
9857If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9858then the caller guarantees that the source and destination pointers are
9859aligned to that boundary.
9860
9861If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memmove`` call
9862is a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is
9863not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9864
9865Semantics:
9866""""""""""
9867
9868The '``llvm.memmove.*``' intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
9869source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
9870copies "len" bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
9871aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009872otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009873
9874'``llvm.memset.*``' Intrinsics
9875^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9876
9877Syntax:
9878"""""""
9879
9880This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer
9881bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets
9882support all bit widths.
9883
9884::
9885
9886 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
9887 i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9888 declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
9889 i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
9890
9891Overview:
9892"""""""""
9893
9894The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
9895particular byte value.
9896
9897Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the ``llvm.memset``
9898intrinsic does not return a value and takes extra alignment/volatile
9899arguments. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
9900
9901Arguments:
9902""""""""""
9903
9904The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second
9905is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an
9906integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth
9907argument is the known alignment of the destination location.
9908
9909If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1,
9910then the caller guarantees that the destination pointer is aligned to
9911that boundary.
9912
9913If the ``isvolatile`` parameter is ``true``, the ``llvm.memset`` call is
9914a :ref:`volatile operation <volatile>`. The detailed access behavior is not
9915very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
9916
9917Semantics:
9918""""""""""
9919
9920The '``llvm.memset.*``' intrinsics fill "len" bytes of memory starting
9921at the destination location. If the argument is known to be aligned to
9922some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise
Bill Wendling61163152013-10-18 23:26:55 +00009923it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +00009924
9925'``llvm.sqrt.*``' Intrinsic
9926^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9927
9928Syntax:
9929"""""""
9930
9931This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sqrt`` on any
9932floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9933all types however.
9934
9935::
9936
9937 declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
9938 declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
9939 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
9940 declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
9941 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
9942
9943Overview:
9944"""""""""
9945
9946The '``llvm.sqrt``' intrinsics return the sqrt of the specified operand,
9947returning the same value as the libm '``sqrt``' functions would. Unlike
9948``sqrt`` in libm, however, ``llvm.sqrt`` has undefined behavior for
9949negative numbers other than -0.0 (which allows for better optimization,
9950because there is no need to worry about errno being set).
9951``llvm.sqrt(-0.0)`` is defined to return -0.0 like IEEE sqrt.
9952
9953Arguments:
9954""""""""""
9955
9956The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
9957type.
9958
9959Semantics:
9960""""""""""
9961
9962This function returns the sqrt of the specified operand if it is a
9963nonnegative floating point number.
9964
9965'``llvm.powi.*``' Intrinsic
9966^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
9967
9968Syntax:
9969"""""""
9970
9971This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.powi`` on any
9972floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
9973all types however.
9974
9975::
9976
9977 declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
9978 declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
9979 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
9980 declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
9981 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
9982
9983Overview:
9984"""""""""
9985
9986The '``llvm.powi.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
9987specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
9988multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating point type is
9989used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
9990
9991Arguments:
9992""""""""""
9993
9994The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to
9995raise to that power.
9996
9997Semantics:
9998""""""""""
9999
10000This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an
10001unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
10002
10003'``llvm.sin.*``' Intrinsic
10004^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10005
10006Syntax:
10007"""""""
10008
10009This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sin`` on any
10010floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10011all types however.
10012
10013::
10014
10015 declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
10016 declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
10017 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10018 declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
10019 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10020
10021Overview:
10022"""""""""
10023
10024The '``llvm.sin.*``' intrinsics return the sine of the operand.
10025
10026Arguments:
10027""""""""""
10028
10029The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10030type.
10031
10032Semantics:
10033""""""""""
10034
10035This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
10036same values as the libm ``sin`` functions would, and handles error
10037conditions in the same way.
10038
10039'``llvm.cos.*``' Intrinsic
10040^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10041
10042Syntax:
10043"""""""
10044
10045This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cos`` on any
10046floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10047all types however.
10048
10049::
10050
10051 declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
10052 declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
10053 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10054 declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
10055 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10056
10057Overview:
10058"""""""""
10059
10060The '``llvm.cos.*``' intrinsics return the cosine of the operand.
10061
10062Arguments:
10063""""""""""
10064
10065The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10066type.
10067
10068Semantics:
10069""""""""""
10070
10071This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
10072same values as the libm ``cos`` functions would, and handles error
10073conditions in the same way.
10074
10075'``llvm.pow.*``' Intrinsic
10076^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10077
10078Syntax:
10079"""""""
10080
10081This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.pow`` on any
10082floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10083all types however.
10084
10085::
10086
10087 declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
10088 declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
10089 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
10090 declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
10091 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
10092
10093Overview:
10094"""""""""
10095
10096The '``llvm.pow.*``' intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
10097specified (positive or negative) power.
10098
10099Arguments:
10100""""""""""
10101
10102The second argument is a floating point power, and the first is a value
10103to raise to that power.
10104
10105Semantics:
10106""""""""""
10107
10108This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
10109returning the same values as the libm ``pow`` functions would, and
10110handles error conditions in the same way.
10111
10112'``llvm.exp.*``' Intrinsic
10113^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10114
10115Syntax:
10116"""""""
10117
10118This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp`` on any
10119floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10120all types however.
10121
10122::
10123
10124 declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
10125 declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
10126 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10127 declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
10128 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10129
10130Overview:
10131"""""""""
10132
10133The '``llvm.exp.*``' intrinsics perform the exp function.
10134
10135Arguments:
10136""""""""""
10137
10138The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10139type.
10140
10141Semantics:
10142""""""""""
10143
10144This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp`` functions
10145would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10146
10147'``llvm.exp2.*``' Intrinsic
10148^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10149
10150Syntax:
10151"""""""
10152
10153This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.exp2`` on any
10154floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10155all types however.
10156
10157::
10158
10159 declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
10160 declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
10161 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10162 declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
10163 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10164
10165Overview:
10166"""""""""
10167
10168The '``llvm.exp2.*``' intrinsics perform the exp2 function.
10169
10170Arguments:
10171""""""""""
10172
10173The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10174type.
10175
10176Semantics:
10177""""""""""
10178
10179This function returns the same values as the libm ``exp2`` functions
10180would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10181
10182'``llvm.log.*``' Intrinsic
10183^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10184
10185Syntax:
10186"""""""
10187
10188This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log`` on any
10189floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10190all types however.
10191
10192::
10193
10194 declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
10195 declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
10196 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10197 declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
10198 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10199
10200Overview:
10201"""""""""
10202
10203The '``llvm.log.*``' intrinsics perform the log function.
10204
10205Arguments:
10206""""""""""
10207
10208The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10209type.
10210
10211Semantics:
10212""""""""""
10213
10214This function returns the same values as the libm ``log`` functions
10215would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10216
10217'``llvm.log10.*``' Intrinsic
10218^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10219
10220Syntax:
10221"""""""
10222
10223This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log10`` on any
10224floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10225all types however.
10226
10227::
10228
10229 declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
10230 declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
10231 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10232 declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
10233 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10234
10235Overview:
10236"""""""""
10237
10238The '``llvm.log10.*``' intrinsics perform the log10 function.
10239
10240Arguments:
10241""""""""""
10242
10243The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10244type.
10245
10246Semantics:
10247""""""""""
10248
10249This function returns the same values as the libm ``log10`` functions
10250would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10251
10252'``llvm.log2.*``' Intrinsic
10253^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10254
10255Syntax:
10256"""""""
10257
10258This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.log2`` on any
10259floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10260all types however.
10261
10262::
10263
10264 declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
10265 declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
10266 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10267 declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
10268 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10269
10270Overview:
10271"""""""""
10272
10273The '``llvm.log2.*``' intrinsics perform the log2 function.
10274
10275Arguments:
10276""""""""""
10277
10278The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10279type.
10280
10281Semantics:
10282""""""""""
10283
10284This function returns the same values as the libm ``log2`` functions
10285would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10286
10287'``llvm.fma.*``' Intrinsic
10288^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10289
10290Syntax:
10291"""""""
10292
10293This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fma`` on any
10294floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10295all types however.
10296
10297::
10298
10299 declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
10300 declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
10301 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
10302 declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
10303 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
10304
10305Overview:
10306"""""""""
10307
10308The '``llvm.fma.*``' intrinsics perform the fused multiply-add
10309operation.
10310
10311Arguments:
10312""""""""""
10313
10314The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10315type.
10316
10317Semantics:
10318""""""""""
10319
10320This function returns the same values as the libm ``fma`` functions
Matt Arsenaultee364ee2014-01-31 00:09:00 +000010321would, and does not set errno.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010322
10323'``llvm.fabs.*``' Intrinsic
10324^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10325
10326Syntax:
10327"""""""
10328
10329This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.fabs`` on any
10330floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10331all types however.
10332
10333::
10334
10335 declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
10336 declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010337 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010338 declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010339 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010340
10341Overview:
10342"""""""""
10343
10344The '``llvm.fabs.*``' intrinsics return the absolute value of the
10345operand.
10346
10347Arguments:
10348""""""""""
10349
10350The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10351type.
10352
10353Semantics:
10354""""""""""
10355
10356This function returns the same values as the libm ``fabs`` functions
10357would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10358
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010359'``llvm.minnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +000010360^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010361
10362Syntax:
10363"""""""
10364
10365This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.minnum`` on any
10366floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10367all types however.
10368
10369::
10370
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +000010371 declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
10372 declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
10373 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
10374 declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
10375 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010376
10377Overview:
10378"""""""""
10379
10380The '``llvm.minnum.*``' intrinsics return the minimum of the two
10381arguments.
10382
10383
10384Arguments:
10385""""""""""
10386
10387The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10388type.
10389
10390Semantics:
10391""""""""""
10392
10393Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, which also match for libm's
10394fmin.
10395
10396If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
10397NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
10398returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
10399fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
10400
10401'``llvm.maxnum.*``' Intrinsic
Matt Arsenault9886b0d2014-10-22 00:15:53 +000010402^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010403
10404Syntax:
10405"""""""
10406
10407This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.maxnum`` on any
10408floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10409all types however.
10410
10411::
10412
Matt Arsenault64313c92014-10-22 18:25:02 +000010413 declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
10414 declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
10415 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
10416 declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
10417 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Matt Arsenaultd6511b42014-10-21 23:00:20 +000010418
10419Overview:
10420"""""""""
10421
10422The '``llvm.maxnum.*``' intrinsics return the maximum of the two
10423arguments.
10424
10425
10426Arguments:
10427""""""""""
10428
10429The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10430type.
10431
10432Semantics:
10433""""""""""
10434Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum, which also match for libm's
10435fmax.
10436
10437If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns
10438NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal,
10439returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that
10440fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
10441
Hal Finkel0c5c01aa2013-08-19 23:35:46 +000010442'``llvm.copysign.*``' Intrinsic
10443^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10444
10445Syntax:
10446"""""""
10447
10448This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.copysign`` on any
10449floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10450all types however.
10451
10452::
10453
10454 declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
10455 declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
10456 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
10457 declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
10458 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
10459
10460Overview:
10461"""""""""
10462
10463The '``llvm.copysign.*``' intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
10464first operand and the sign of the second operand.
10465
10466Arguments:
10467""""""""""
10468
10469The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10470type.
10471
10472Semantics:
10473""""""""""
10474
10475This function returns the same values as the libm ``copysign``
10476functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10477
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010478'``llvm.floor.*``' Intrinsic
10479^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10480
10481Syntax:
10482"""""""
10483
10484This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.floor`` on any
10485floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10486all types however.
10487
10488::
10489
10490 declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
10491 declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
10492 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10493 declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
10494 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10495
10496Overview:
10497"""""""""
10498
10499The '``llvm.floor.*``' intrinsics return the floor of the operand.
10500
10501Arguments:
10502""""""""""
10503
10504The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10505type.
10506
10507Semantics:
10508""""""""""
10509
10510This function returns the same values as the libm ``floor`` functions
10511would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10512
10513'``llvm.ceil.*``' Intrinsic
10514^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10515
10516Syntax:
10517"""""""
10518
10519This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ceil`` on any
10520floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10521all types however.
10522
10523::
10524
10525 declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
10526 declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
10527 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10528 declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
10529 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10530
10531Overview:
10532"""""""""
10533
10534The '``llvm.ceil.*``' intrinsics return the ceiling of the operand.
10535
10536Arguments:
10537""""""""""
10538
10539The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10540type.
10541
10542Semantics:
10543""""""""""
10544
10545This function returns the same values as the libm ``ceil`` functions
10546would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10547
10548'``llvm.trunc.*``' Intrinsic
10549^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10550
10551Syntax:
10552"""""""
10553
10554This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.trunc`` on any
10555floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10556all types however.
10557
10558::
10559
10560 declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
10561 declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
10562 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10563 declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
10564 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10565
10566Overview:
10567"""""""""
10568
10569The '``llvm.trunc.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10570nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
10571
10572Arguments:
10573""""""""""
10574
10575The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10576type.
10577
10578Semantics:
10579""""""""""
10580
10581This function returns the same values as the libm ``trunc`` functions
10582would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10583
10584'``llvm.rint.*``' Intrinsic
10585^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10586
10587Syntax:
10588"""""""
10589
10590This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.rint`` on any
10591floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10592all types however.
10593
10594::
10595
10596 declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
10597 declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
10598 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10599 declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
10600 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10601
10602Overview:
10603"""""""""
10604
10605The '``llvm.rint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10606nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
10607operand isn't an integer.
10608
10609Arguments:
10610""""""""""
10611
10612The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10613type.
10614
10615Semantics:
10616""""""""""
10617
10618This function returns the same values as the libm ``rint`` functions
10619would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10620
10621'``llvm.nearbyint.*``' Intrinsic
10622^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10623
10624Syntax:
10625"""""""
10626
10627This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.nearbyint`` on any
10628floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10629all types however.
10630
10631::
10632
10633 declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
10634 declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
10635 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10636 declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
10637 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10638
10639Overview:
10640"""""""""
10641
10642The '``llvm.nearbyint.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10643nearest integer.
10644
10645Arguments:
10646""""""""""
10647
10648The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10649type.
10650
10651Semantics:
10652""""""""""
10653
10654This function returns the same values as the libm ``nearbyint``
10655functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10656
Hal Finkel171817e2013-08-07 22:49:12 +000010657'``llvm.round.*``' Intrinsic
10658^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10659
10660Syntax:
10661"""""""
10662
10663This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.round`` on any
10664floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
10665all types however.
10666
10667::
10668
10669 declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
10670 declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
10671 declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
10672 declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
10673 declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
10674
10675Overview:
10676"""""""""
10677
10678The '``llvm.round.*``' intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
10679nearest integer.
10680
10681Arguments:
10682""""""""""
10683
10684The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same
10685type.
10686
10687Semantics:
10688""""""""""
10689
10690This function returns the same values as the libm ``round``
10691functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
10692
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010693Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
10694---------------------------
10695
10696LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation
10697operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
10698
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000010699'``llvm.bitreverse.*``' Intrinsics
Akira Hatanaka7f5562b2015-11-13 21:09:57 +000010700^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000010701
10702Syntax:
10703"""""""
10704
10705This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any
10706integer type.
10707
10708::
10709
10710 declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
10711 declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
10712 declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
10713
10714Overview:
10715"""""""""
10716
10717The '``llvm.bitreverse``' family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
Matt Arsenaultde2d6a32016-03-07 21:54:52 +000010718bitpattern of an integer value; for example ``0b10110110`` becomes
10719``0b01101101``.
James Molloy90111f72015-11-12 12:29:09 +000010720
10721Semantics:
10722""""""""""
10723
10724The ``llvm.bitreverse.iN`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has bit
10725``M`` in the input moved to bit ``N-M`` in the output.
10726
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010727'``llvm.bswap.*``' Intrinsics
10728^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10729
10730Syntax:
10731"""""""
10732
10733This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any
10734integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
10735
10736::
10737
10738 declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
10739 declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
10740 declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
10741
10742Overview:
10743"""""""""
10744
10745The '``llvm.bswap``' family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
10746values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits).
10747These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the
10748target's native byte order.
10749
10750Semantics:
10751""""""""""
10752
10753The ``llvm.bswap.i16`` intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
10754and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the ``llvm.bswap.i32``
10755intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
10756swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
10757returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
10758``llvm.bswap.i48``, ``llvm.bswap.i64`` and other intrinsics extend this
10759concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
10760respectively).
10761
10762'``llvm.ctpop.*``' Intrinsic
10763^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10764
10765Syntax:
10766"""""""
10767
10768This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer
10769bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets
10770support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10771
10772::
10773
10774 declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
10775 declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
10776 declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
10777 declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
10778 declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
10779 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
10780
10781Overview:
10782"""""""""
10783
10784The '``llvm.ctpop``' family of intrinsics counts the number of bits set
10785in a value.
10786
10787Arguments:
10788""""""""""
10789
10790The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any
10791integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must
10792match the argument type.
10793
10794Semantics:
10795""""""""""
10796
10797The '``llvm.ctpop``' intrinsic counts the 1's in a variable, or within
10798each element of a vector.
10799
10800'``llvm.ctlz.*``' Intrinsic
10801^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10802
10803Syntax:
10804"""""""
10805
10806This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ctlz`` on any
10807integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
10808targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10809
10810::
10811
10812 declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10813 declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10814 declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10815 declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10816 declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Alexey Samsonovc4b18302016-03-17 23:08:01 +000010817 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010818
10819Overview:
10820"""""""""
10821
10822The '``llvm.ctlz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
10823leading zeros in a variable.
10824
10825Arguments:
10826""""""""""
10827
10828The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000010829any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010830type must match the first argument type.
10831
10832The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
10833the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
10834defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
10835defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
10836now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
10837
10838Semantics:
10839""""""""""
10840
10841The '``llvm.ctlz``' intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
10842zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
10843``src == 0`` then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src``
10844if ``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
10845``llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30``.
10846
10847'``llvm.cttz.*``' Intrinsic
10848^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10849
10850Syntax:
10851"""""""
10852
10853This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.cttz`` on any
10854integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
10855support all bit widths or vector types, however.
10856
10857::
10858
10859 declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10860 declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10861 declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10862 declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
10863 declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Alexey Samsonovc4b18302016-03-17 23:08:01 +000010864 declare <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010865
10866Overview:
10867"""""""""
10868
10869The '``llvm.cttz``' family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
10870trailing zeros.
10871
10872Arguments:
10873""""""""""
10874
10875The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of
Hal Finkel5dd82782015-01-05 04:05:21 +000010876any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010877type must match the first argument type.
10878
10879The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether
10880the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a
10881defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a
10882defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are
10883now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
10884
10885Semantics:
10886""""""""""
10887
10888The '``llvm.cttz``' intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
10889zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If ``src == 0``
10890then the result is the size in bits of the type of ``src`` if
10891``is_zero_undef == 0`` and ``undef`` otherwise. For example,
10892``llvm.cttz(2) = 1``.
10893
Philip Reames34843ae2015-03-05 05:55:55 +000010894.. _int_overflow:
10895
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010896Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
10897-----------------------------------
10898
John Regehr6a493f22016-05-12 20:55:09 +000010899LLVM provides intrinsics for fast arithmetic overflow checking.
10900
10901Each of these intrinsics returns a two-element struct. The first
10902element of this struct contains the result of the corresponding
10903arithmetic operation modulo 2\ :sup:`n`\ , where n is the bit width of
10904the result. Therefore, for example, the first element of the struct
10905returned by ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32`` is always the same as the
10906result of a 32-bit ``add`` instruction with the same operands, where
10907the ``add`` is *not* modified by an ``nsw`` or ``nuw`` flag.
10908
10909The second element of the result is an ``i1`` that is 1 if the
10910arithmetic operation overflowed and 0 otherwise. An operation
10911overflows if, for any values of its operands ``A`` and ``B`` and for
10912any ``N`` larger than the operands' width, ``ext(A op B) to iN`` is
10913not equal to ``(ext(A) to iN) op (ext(B) to iN)`` where ``ext`` is
10914``sext`` for signed overflow and ``zext`` for unsigned overflow, and
10915``op`` is the underlying arithmetic operation.
10916
10917The behavior of these intrinsics is well-defined for all argument
10918values.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010919
10920'``llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10921^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10922
10923Syntax:
10924"""""""
10925
10926This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``
10927on any integer bit width.
10928
10929::
10930
10931 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10932 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10933 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10934
10935Overview:
10936"""""""""
10937
10938The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10939a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
10940occurred during the signed summation.
10941
10942Arguments:
10943""""""""""
10944
10945The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10946may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10947bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10948``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
10949addition.
10950
10951Semantics:
10952""""""""""
10953
10954The '``llvm.sadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000010955a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000010956first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
10957of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
10958overflow.
10959
10960Examples:
10961"""""""""
10962
10963.. code-block:: llvm
10964
10965 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10966 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
10967 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
10968 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
10969
10970'``llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
10971^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
10972
10973Syntax:
10974"""""""
10975
10976This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``
10977on any integer bit width.
10978
10979::
10980
10981 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
10982 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
10983 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
10984
10985Overview:
10986"""""""""
10987
10988The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
10989an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
10990occurred during the unsigned summation.
10991
10992Arguments:
10993""""""""""
10994
10995The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
10996may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
10997bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
10998``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
10999addition.
11000
11001Semantics:
11002""""""""""
11003
11004The '``llvm.uadd.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011005an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011006first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
11007bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
11008
11009Examples:
11010"""""""""
11011
11012.. code-block:: llvm
11013
11014 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11015 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11016 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11017 br i1 %obit, label %carry, label %normal
11018
11019'``llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11020^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11021
11022Syntax:
11023"""""""
11024
11025This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``
11026on any integer bit width.
11027
11028::
11029
11030 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11031 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11032 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11033
11034Overview:
11035"""""""""
11036
11037The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11038a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11039overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
11040
11041Arguments:
11042""""""""""
11043
11044The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11045may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11046bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11047``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
11048subtraction.
11049
11050Semantics:
11051""""""""""
11052
11053The '``llvm.ssub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011054a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure --- the
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011055first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
11056which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
11057overflow.
11058
11059Examples:
11060"""""""""
11061
11062.. code-block:: llvm
11063
11064 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11065 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11066 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11067 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11068
11069'``llvm.usub.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11070^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11071
11072Syntax:
11073"""""""
11074
11075This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.usub.with.overflow``
11076on any integer bit width.
11077
11078::
11079
11080 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11081 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11082 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11083
11084Overview:
11085"""""""""
11086
11087The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11088an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11089overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
11090
11091Arguments:
11092""""""""""
11093
11094The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11095may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11096bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11097``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
11098subtraction.
11099
11100Semantics:
11101""""""""""
11102
11103The '``llvm.usub.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011104an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011105the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
11106which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
11107overflow.
11108
11109Examples:
11110"""""""""
11111
11112.. code-block:: llvm
11113
11114 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11115 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11116 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11117 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11118
11119'``llvm.smul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11120^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11121
11122Syntax:
11123"""""""
11124
11125This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.smul.with.overflow``
11126on any integer bit width.
11127
11128::
11129
11130 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11131 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11132 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11133
11134Overview:
11135"""""""""
11136
11137The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11138a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11139overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
11140
11141Arguments:
11142""""""""""
11143
11144The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11145may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11146bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11147``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo signed
11148multiplication.
11149
11150Semantics:
11151""""""""""
11152
11153The '``llvm.smul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011154a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011155the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
11156of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
11157overflow.
11158
11159Examples:
11160"""""""""
11161
11162.. code-block:: llvm
11163
11164 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11165 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11166 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11167 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11168
11169'``llvm.umul.with.overflow.*``' Intrinsics
11170^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11171
11172Syntax:
11173"""""""
11174
11175This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.umul.with.overflow``
11176on any integer bit width.
11177
11178::
11179
11180 declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
11181 declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11182 declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
11183
11184Overview:
11185"""""""""
11186
11187The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
11188a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
11189overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
11190
11191Arguments:
11192""""""""""
11193
11194The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
11195may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
11196bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
11197``i1``. ``%a`` and ``%b`` are the two values that will undergo unsigned
11198multiplication.
11199
11200Semantics:
11201""""""""""
11202
11203The '``llvm.umul.with.overflow``' family of intrinsic functions perform
Dmitri Gribenkoe8131122013-01-19 20:34:20 +000011204an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure ---
11205the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011206element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
11207resulted in an overflow.
11208
11209Examples:
11210"""""""""
11211
11212.. code-block:: llvm
11213
11214 %res = call {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
11215 %sum = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 0
11216 %obit = extractvalue {i32, i1} %res, 1
11217 br i1 %obit, label %overflow, label %normal
11218
11219Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
11220---------------------------------
11221
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011222'``llvm.canonicalize.*``' Intrinsic
11223^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11224
11225Syntax:
11226"""""""
11227
11228::
11229
11230 declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
11231 declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
11232
11233Overview:
11234"""""""""
11235
11236The '``llvm.canonicalize.*``' intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011237encoding of a floating point number. This canonicalization is useful for
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011238implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
11239defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
11240
11241::
11242
11243 2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011244 representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011245 numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
11246
11247This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011248conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011249according to section 6.2.
11250
11251Examples of non-canonical encodings:
11252
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011253- x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011254 converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
11255- Many normal decimal floating point numbers have non-canonical alternative
11256 encodings.
11257- Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values.
Sanjay Patelcc330962016-02-24 23:44:19 +000011258 These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and will be flushed to
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011259 a zero of the same sign by this operation.
11260
11261Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with
11262default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a
11263quiet NaN result.
11264
11265This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011266that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
112671.0 and ``llvm.minnum(x, x)`` are possible implementations. Addition with
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011268-0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
11269
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011270``@llvm.canonicalize`` must preserve the equality relation. That is:
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011271
11272- ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)`` is equivalent to ``(x == x)``
11273- ``(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))`` is equivalent to
11274 to ``(x == y)``
11275
11276Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
11277``@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0`` and ``@llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0``
11278
11279The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions.
11280First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011281must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011282usual methods.
11283
11284The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
11285
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011286- The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011287 floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
11288- The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point
Sean Silvaa1190322015-08-06 22:56:48 +000011289 operations. That is, the bits of the floating point value are not examined.
Owen Anderson1056a922015-07-11 07:01:27 +000011290
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011291'``llvm.fmuladd.*``' Intrinsic
11292^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11293
11294Syntax:
11295"""""""
11296
11297::
11298
11299 declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
11300 declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
11301
11302Overview:
11303"""""""""
11304
11305The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
Lang Hames045f4392013-01-17 00:00:49 +000011306expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
11307target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
11308fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
11309and add instructions.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011310
11311Arguments:
11312""""""""""
11313
11314The '``llvm.fmuladd.*``' intrinsics each take three arguments: two
11315multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
11316
11317Semantics:
11318""""""""""
11319
11320The expression:
11321
11322::
11323
11324 %0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
11325
11326is equivalent to the expression a \* b + c, except that rounding will
11327not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
11328code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
11329the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
Matt Arsenaultee364ee2014-01-31 00:09:00 +000011330corresponding llvm.fma.\* intrinsic function should be used
11331instead. This never sets errno, just as '``llvm.fma.*``'.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011332
11333Examples:
11334"""""""""
11335
11336.. code-block:: llvm
11337
Tim Northover675a0962014-06-13 14:24:23 +000011338 %r2 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c) ; yields float:r2 = (a * b) + c
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011339
11340Half Precision Floating Point Intrinsics
11341----------------------------------------
11342
11343For most target platforms, half precision floating point is a
11344storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory)
11345but does not support computation in the format.
11346
11347This means that code must first load the half-precision floating point
11348value as an i16, then convert it to float with
11349:ref:`llvm.convert.from.fp16 <int_convert_from_fp16>`. Computation can
11350then be performed on the float value (including extending to double
11351etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float
11352if needed, then converted to i16 with
11353:ref:`llvm.convert.to.fp16 <int_convert_to_fp16>`, then storing as an
11354i16 value.
11355
11356.. _int_convert_to_fp16:
11357
11358'``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' Intrinsic
11359^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11360
11361Syntax:
11362"""""""
11363
11364::
11365
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011366 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
11367 declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011368
11369Overview:
11370"""""""""
11371
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011372The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
11373conventional floating point type to half precision floating point format.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011374
11375Arguments:
11376""""""""""
11377
11378The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
11379converted.
11380
11381Semantics:
11382""""""""""
11383
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011384The '``llvm.convert.to.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
11385conventional floating point format to half precision floating point format. The
11386return value is an ``i16`` which contains the converted number.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011387
11388Examples:
11389"""""""""
11390
11391.. code-block:: llvm
11392
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011393 %res = call i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011394 store i16 %res, i16* @x, align 2
11395
11396.. _int_convert_from_fp16:
11397
11398'``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' Intrinsic
11399^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11400
11401Syntax:
11402"""""""
11403
11404::
11405
Tim Northoverfd7e4242014-07-17 10:51:23 +000011406 declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
11407 declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011408
11409Overview:
11410"""""""""
11411
11412The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
11413conversion from half precision floating point format to single precision
11414floating point format.
11415
11416Arguments:
11417""""""""""
11418
11419The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be
11420converted.
11421
11422Semantics:
11423""""""""""
11424
11425The '``llvm.convert.from.fp16``' intrinsic function performs a
11426conversion from half single precision floating point format to single
11427precision floating point format. The input half-float value is
11428represented by an ``i16`` value.
11429
11430Examples:
11431"""""""""
11432
11433.. code-block:: llvm
11434
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000011435 %a = load i16, i16* @x, align 2
Matt Arsenault3e3ddda2014-07-10 03:22:16 +000011436 %res = call float @llvm.convert.from.fp16(i16 %a)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011437
Duncan P. N. Exon Smithe2741802015-03-03 17:24:31 +000011438.. _dbg_intrinsics:
11439
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011440Debugger Intrinsics
11441-------------------
11442
11443The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with ``llvm.dbg.``
11444prefix), are described in the `LLVM Source Level
11445Debugging <SourceLevelDebugging.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_
11446document.
11447
11448Exception Handling Intrinsics
11449-----------------------------
11450
11451The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
11452``llvm.eh.`` prefix), are described in the `LLVM Exception
11453Handling <ExceptionHandling.html#format_common_intrinsics>`_ document.
11454
11455.. _int_trampoline:
11456
11457Trampoline Intrinsics
11458---------------------
11459
11460These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with
11461the :ref:`nest <nest>` attribute, from a function. The result is a
11462callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does
11463not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored
11464in advance in a "trampoline", a block of memory usually allocated on the
11465stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the
11466argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address
11467extension.
11468
11469For example, if the function is ``i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)``
11470then the resulting function pointer has signature ``i32 (i32, i32)*``.
11471It can be created as follows:
11472
11473.. code-block:: llvm
11474
11475 %tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
David Blaikie16a97eb2015-03-04 22:02:58 +000011476 %tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011477 call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
11478 %p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
11479 %fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
11480
11481The call ``%val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)`` is then equivalent to
11482``%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)``.
11483
11484.. _int_it:
11485
11486'``llvm.init.trampoline``' Intrinsic
11487^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11488
11489Syntax:
11490"""""""
11491
11492::
11493
11494 declare void @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* <tramp>, i8* <func>, i8* <nval>)
11495
11496Overview:
11497"""""""""
11498
11499This fills the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` with executable code,
11500turning it into a trampoline.
11501
11502Arguments:
11503""""""""""
11504
11505The ``llvm.init.trampoline`` intrinsic takes three arguments, all
11506pointers. The ``tramp`` argument must point to a sufficiently large and
11507sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
11508intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
11509LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
11510front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
11511target-specific knowledge. The ``func`` argument must hold a function
11512bitcast to an ``i8*``.
11513
11514Semantics:
11515""""""""""
11516
11517The block of memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is filled with target
11518dependent code, turning it into a function. Then ``tramp`` needs to be
11519passed to :ref:`llvm.adjust.trampoline <int_at>` to get a pointer which can
11520be :ref:`bitcast (to a new function) and called <int_trampoline>`. The new
11521function's signature is the same as that of ``func`` with any arguments
11522marked with the ``nest`` attribute removed. At most one such ``nest``
11523argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
11524function is equivalent to calling ``func`` with the same argument list,
11525but with ``nval`` used for the missing ``nest`` argument. If, after
11526calling ``llvm.init.trampoline``, the memory pointed to by ``tramp`` is
11527modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
11528pointer is undefined.
11529
11530.. _int_at:
11531
11532'``llvm.adjust.trampoline``' Intrinsic
11533^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11534
11535Syntax:
11536"""""""
11537
11538::
11539
11540 declare i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* <tramp>)
11541
11542Overview:
11543"""""""""
11544
11545This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
11546a trampoline (passed as ``tramp``).
11547
11548Arguments:
11549""""""""""
11550
11551``tramp`` must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
11552code filled in by a previous call to
11553:ref:`llvm.init.trampoline <int_it>`.
11554
11555Semantics:
11556""""""""""
11557
11558On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000011559different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011560intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to ``tramp``
11561after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
11562returned can then be :ref:`bitcast and executed <int_trampoline>`.
11563
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011564.. _int_mload_mstore:
11565
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011566Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
11567---------------------------------------
11568
11569LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
11570
11571.. _int_mload:
11572
11573'``llvm.masked.load.*``' Intrinsics
11574^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11575
11576Syntax:
11577"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011578This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011579
11580::
11581
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011582 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
11583 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64.p0v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011584 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011585 declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011586 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011587 declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f.p0v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011588
11589Overview:
11590"""""""""
11591
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011592Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011593
11594
11595Arguments:
11596""""""""""
11597
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011598The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011599
11600
11601Semantics:
11602""""""""""
11603
11604The '``llvm.masked.load``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
11605The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a 'select' between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
11606
11607
11608::
11609
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011610 %res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000011611
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011612 ;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000011613 %loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000011614 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011615
11616.. _int_mstore:
11617
11618'``llvm.masked.store.*``' Intrinsics
11619^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11620
11621Syntax:
11622"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011623This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011624
11625::
11626
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011627 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32.p0v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
11628 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011629 ;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011630 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64.p0v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011631 ;; The data is a vector of function pointers
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011632 declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f.p0v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011633
11634Overview:
11635"""""""""
11636
11637Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
11638
11639Arguments:
11640""""""""""
11641
11642The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
11643
11644
11645Semantics:
11646""""""""""
11647
11648The '``llvm.masked.store``' intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
11649The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
11650
11651::
11652
Artur Pilipenko7ad95ec2016-06-28 18:27:25 +000011653 call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32.p0v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
Mehdi Amini4a121fa2015-03-14 22:04:06 +000011654
Elena Demikhovskye86c8c82014-12-29 09:47:51 +000011655 ;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
David Blaikiec7aabbb2015-03-04 22:06:14 +000011656 %oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Elena Demikhovsky3d13f1c2014-12-25 09:29:13 +000011657 %res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
11658 store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
11659
11660
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011661Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
11662-------------------------------------------
11663
11664LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to :ref:`Masked Vector Load and Store <int_mload_mstore>`, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the "off" lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
11665
11666.. _int_mgather:
11667
11668'``llvm.masked.gather.*``' Intrinsics
11669^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11670
11671Syntax:
11672"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011673This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011674
11675::
11676
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011677 declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
11678 declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64 (<2 x double*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
11679 declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011680
11681Overview:
11682"""""""""
11683
11684Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers '``ptrs``'. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the '``passthru``' operand.
11685
11686
11687Arguments:
11688""""""""""
11689
11690The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the '``passthru``' operand are the same vector types.
11691
11692
11693Semantics:
11694""""""""""
11695
11696The '``llvm.masked.gather``' intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
11697The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
11698
11699
11700::
11701
11702 %res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1>%mask, <4 x double> <true, true, true, true>)
11703
11704 ;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
11705 %ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
11706 %ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
11707 %ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
11708 %ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
11709
11710 %val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
11711 %val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
11712 %val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
11713 %val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
11714
11715 %vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
11716 %vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
11717 %vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
11718 %vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
11719
11720.. _int_mscatter:
11721
11722'``llvm.masked.scatter.*``' Intrinsics
11723^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11724
11725Syntax:
11726"""""""
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011727This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011728
11729::
11730
Elena Demikhovsky1ca72e12015-11-19 07:17:16 +000011731 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
11732 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
11733 declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011734
11735Overview:
11736"""""""""
11737
11738Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
11739
11740Arguments:
11741""""""""""
11742
11743The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
11744
11745
11746Semantics:
11747""""""""""
11748
Bruce Mitchenere9ffb452015-09-12 01:17:08 +000011749The '``llvm.masked.scatter``' intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011750
11751::
11752
Sylvestre Ledru84666a12016-02-14 20:16:22 +000011753 ;; This instruction unconditionally stores data vector in multiple addresses
Elena Demikhovsky82cdd652015-05-07 12:25:11 +000011754 call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
11755
11756 ;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
11757 %val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
11758 %val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
11759 ..
11760 %val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
11761 %ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
11762 %ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
11763 ..
11764 %ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
11765 ;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
11766 store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
11767 store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
11768 ..
11769 store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
11770
11771
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011772Memory Use Markers
11773------------------
11774
Sanjay Patel69bf48e2014-07-04 19:40:43 +000011775This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011776memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
11777
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000011778.. _int_lifestart:
11779
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011780'``llvm.lifetime.start``' Intrinsic
11781^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11782
11783Syntax:
11784"""""""
11785
11786::
11787
11788 declare void @llvm.lifetime.start(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11789
11790Overview:
11791"""""""""
11792
11793The '``llvm.lifetime.start``' intrinsic specifies the start of a memory
11794object's lifetime.
11795
11796Arguments:
11797""""""""""
11798
11799The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11800object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11801to the object.
11802
11803Semantics:
11804""""""""""
11805
11806This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
11807of the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known
11808to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
11809that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with ``'undef'``.
11810
Reid Klecknera534a382013-12-19 02:14:12 +000011811.. _int_lifeend:
11812
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011813'``llvm.lifetime.end``' Intrinsic
11814^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11815
11816Syntax:
11817"""""""
11818
11819::
11820
11821 declare void @llvm.lifetime.end(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
11822
11823Overview:
11824"""""""""
11825
11826The '``llvm.lifetime.end``' intrinsic specifies the end of a memory
11827object's lifetime.
11828
11829Arguments:
11830""""""""""
11831
11832The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11833object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11834to the object.
11835
11836Semantics:
11837""""""""""
11838
11839This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
11840the memory pointed to by ``ptr`` is dead. This means that it is known to
11841never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
11842object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
11843
11844'``llvm.invariant.start``' Intrinsic
11845^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11846
11847Syntax:
11848"""""""
Anna Thomas0be4a0e2016-07-22 17:49:40 +000011849This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011850
11851::
11852
Anna Thomas0be4a0e2016-07-22 17:49:40 +000011853 declare {}* @llvm.invariant.start.p0i8(i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011854
11855Overview:
11856"""""""""
11857
11858The '``llvm.invariant.start``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of
11859a memory object will not change.
11860
11861Arguments:
11862""""""""""
11863
11864The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11865object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer
11866to the object.
11867
11868Semantics:
11869""""""""""
11870
11871This intrinsic indicates that until an ``llvm.invariant.end`` that uses
11872the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
11873unchanging.
11874
11875'``llvm.invariant.end``' Intrinsic
11876^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11877
11878Syntax:
11879"""""""
Anna Thomas0be4a0e2016-07-22 17:49:40 +000011880This is an overloaded intrinsic. The memory object can belong to any address space.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011881
11882::
11883
Anna Thomas0be4a0e2016-07-22 17:49:40 +000011884 declare void @llvm.invariant.end.p0i8({}* <start>, i64 <size>, i8* nocapture <ptr>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011885
11886Overview:
11887"""""""""
11888
11889The '``llvm.invariant.end``' intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
11890memory object are mutable.
11891
11892Arguments:
11893""""""""""
11894
11895The first argument is the matching ``llvm.invariant.start`` intrinsic.
11896The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
11897object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
11898pointer to the object.
11899
11900Semantics:
11901""""""""""
11902
11903This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
11904
Piotr Padlewski6c15ec42015-09-15 18:32:14 +000011905'``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' Intrinsic
11906^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11907
11908Syntax:
11909"""""""
11910
11911::
11912
11913 declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* <ptr>)
11914
11915Overview:
11916"""""""""
11917
11918The '``llvm.invariant.group.barrier``' intrinsic can be used when an invariant
11919established by invariant.group metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
11920value that does not carry the invariant information.
11921
11922
11923Arguments:
11924""""""""""
11925
11926The ``llvm.invariant.group.barrier`` takes only one argument, which is
11927the pointer to the memory for which the ``invariant.group`` no longer holds.
11928
11929Semantics:
11930""""""""""
11931
11932Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
11933for the purposes of ``load``/``store`` ``invariant.group`` metadata.
11934
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000011935General Intrinsics
11936------------------
11937
11938This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific
11939purpose.
11940
11941'``llvm.var.annotation``' Intrinsic
11942^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11943
11944Syntax:
11945"""""""
11946
11947::
11948
11949 declare void @llvm.var.annotation(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11950
11951Overview:
11952"""""""""
11953
11954The '``llvm.var.annotation``' intrinsic.
11955
11956Arguments:
11957""""""""""
11958
11959The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a
11960global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the
11961source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
11962
11963Semantics:
11964""""""""""
11965
11966This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary
11967strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want
11968to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are
11969ignored by code generation and optimization.
11970
Michael Gottesman88d18832013-03-26 00:34:27 +000011971'``llvm.ptr.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
11972^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
11973
11974Syntax:
11975"""""""
11976
11977This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' on a
11978pointer to an integer of any width. *NOTE* you must specify an address space for
11979the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
11980'``0``'.
11981
11982::
11983
11984 declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11985 declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11986 declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11987 declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11988 declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
11989
11990Overview:
11991"""""""""
11992
11993The '``llvm.ptr.annotation``' intrinsic.
11994
11995Arguments:
11996""""""""""
11997
11998The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth
11999(result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the
12000third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the
12001last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
12002
12003Semantics:
12004""""""""""
12005
12006This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary
12007strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look
12008for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code
12009generation and optimization.
12010
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012011'``llvm.annotation.*``' Intrinsic
12012^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12013
12014Syntax:
12015"""""""
12016
12017This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use '``llvm.annotation``' on
12018any integer bit width.
12019
12020::
12021
12022 declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
12023 declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
12024 declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
12025 declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
12026 declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
12027
12028Overview:
12029"""""""""
12030
12031The '``llvm.annotation``' intrinsic.
12032
12033Arguments:
12034""""""""""
12035
12036The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the
12037second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a
12038global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is
12039the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
12040
12041Semantics:
12042""""""""""
12043
12044This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions
12045with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose
12046optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no
12047other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
12048
12049'``llvm.trap``' Intrinsic
12050^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12051
12052Syntax:
12053"""""""
12054
12055::
12056
12057 declare void @llvm.trap() noreturn nounwind
12058
12059Overview:
12060"""""""""
12061
12062The '``llvm.trap``' intrinsic.
12063
12064Arguments:
12065""""""""""
12066
12067None.
12068
12069Semantics:
12070""""""""""
12071
12072This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
12073the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
12074lowered to a call of the ``abort()`` function.
12075
12076'``llvm.debugtrap``' Intrinsic
12077^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12078
12079Syntax:
12080"""""""
12081
12082::
12083
12084 declare void @llvm.debugtrap() nounwind
12085
12086Overview:
12087"""""""""
12088
12089The '``llvm.debugtrap``' intrinsic.
12090
12091Arguments:
12092""""""""""
12093
12094None.
12095
12096Semantics:
12097""""""""""
12098
12099This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an
12100execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a
12101debugger.
12102
12103'``llvm.stackprotector``' Intrinsic
12104^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12105
12106Syntax:
12107"""""""
12108
12109::
12110
12111 declare void @llvm.stackprotector(i8* <guard>, i8** <slot>)
12112
12113Overview:
12114"""""""""
12115
12116The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic takes the ``guard`` and stores it
12117onto the stack at ``slot``. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
12118is placed on the stack before local variables.
12119
12120Arguments:
12121""""""""""
12122
12123The ``llvm.stackprotector`` intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
12124The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
12125``@__stack_chk_guard``. The second variable is an ``alloca`` that has
12126enough space to hold the value of the guard.
12127
12128Semantics:
12129""""""""""
12130
Michael Gottesmandafc7d92013-08-12 18:35:32 +000012131This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
12132the ``AllocaInst`` stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
12133to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
12134the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
12135checked against the original guard by ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck``. If they are
12136different, then ``llvm.stackprotectorcheck`` causes the program to abort by
12137calling the ``__stack_chk_fail()`` function.
12138
Tim Shene885d5e2016-04-19 19:40:37 +000012139'``llvm.stackguard``' Intrinsic
12140^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12141
12142Syntax:
12143"""""""
12144
12145::
12146
12147 declare i8* @llvm.stackguard()
12148
12149Overview:
12150"""""""""
12151
12152The ``llvm.stackguard`` intrinsic returns the system stack guard value.
12153
12154It should not be generated by frontends, since it is only for internal usage.
12155The reason why we create this intrinsic is that we still support IR form Stack
12156Protector in FastISel.
12157
12158Arguments:
12159""""""""""
12160
12161None.
12162
12163Semantics:
12164""""""""""
12165
12166On some platforms, the value returned by this intrinsic remains unchanged
12167between loads in the same thread. On other platforms, it returns the same
12168global variable value, if any, e.g. ``@__stack_chk_guard``.
12169
12170Currently some platforms have IR-level customized stack guard loading (e.g.
12171X86 Linux) that is not handled by ``llvm.stackguard()``, while they should be
12172in the future.
12173
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012174'``llvm.objectsize``' Intrinsic
12175^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12176
12177Syntax:
12178"""""""
12179
12180::
12181
12182 declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
12183 declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
12184
12185Overview:
12186"""""""""
12187
12188The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is designed to provide information to
12189the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation
12190(like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or
12191b) that a runtime check for overflow isn't necessary. An object in this
12192context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or
12193other object.
12194
12195Arguments:
12196""""""""""
12197
12198The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first
12199argument is a pointer to or into the ``object``. The second argument is
12200a boolean and determines whether ``llvm.objectsize`` returns 0 (if true)
12201or -1 (if false) when the object size is unknown. The second argument
12202only accepts constants.
12203
12204Semantics:
12205""""""""""
12206
12207The ``llvm.objectsize`` intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing
12208the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at
12209compile time, ``llvm.objectsize`` returns ``i32/i64 -1 or 0`` (depending
12210on the ``min`` argument).
12211
12212'``llvm.expect``' Intrinsic
12213^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12214
12215Syntax:
12216"""""""
12217
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000012218This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ``llvm.expect`` on any
12219integer bit width.
12220
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012221::
12222
Duncan P. N. Exon Smith1ff08e32014-02-02 22:43:55 +000012223 declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012224 declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
12225 declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
12226
12227Overview:
12228"""""""""
12229
12230The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic provides information about expected (the
12231most probable) value of ``val``, which can be used by optimizers.
12232
12233Arguments:
12234""""""""""
12235
12236The ``llvm.expect`` intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
12237a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
12238constant value, variables are not allowed.
12239
12240Semantics:
12241""""""""""
12242
12243This intrinsic is lowered to the ``val``.
12244
Philip Reamese0e90832015-04-26 22:23:12 +000012245.. _int_assume:
12246
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000012247'``llvm.assume``' Intrinsic
12248^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12249
12250Syntax:
12251"""""""
12252
12253::
12254
12255 declare void @llvm.assume(i1 %cond)
12256
12257Overview:
12258"""""""""
12259
12260The ``llvm.assume`` allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
12261condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
12262of the code.
12263
12264Arguments:
12265""""""""""
12266
12267The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
12268
12269Semantics:
12270""""""""""
12271
12272The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is
12273always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is
12274generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the
12275provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is
12276violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
12277
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000012278Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000012279used by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
12280only used to form the intrinsic's input argument. This might prove undesirable
Sanjay Patel1ed2bb52015-01-14 16:03:58 +000012281if the extra information provided by the ``llvm.assume`` intrinsic does not cause
Hal Finkel93046912014-07-25 21:13:35 +000012282sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
12283``llvm.assume`` should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
12284that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
12285optimizer.
12286
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000012287.. _type.test:
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000012288
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000012289'``llvm.type.test``' Intrinsic
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000012290^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12291
12292Syntax:
12293"""""""
12294
12295::
12296
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000012297 declare i1 @llvm.type.test(i8* %ptr, metadata %type) nounwind readnone
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000012298
12299
12300Arguments:
12301""""""""""
12302
12303The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000012304metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier <TypeMetadata>`.
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000012305
12306Overview:
12307"""""""""
12308
Peter Collingbourne7efd7502016-06-24 21:21:32 +000012309The ``llvm.type.test`` intrinsic tests whether the given pointer is associated
12310with the given type identifier.
Peter Collingbournee6909c82015-02-20 20:30:47 +000012311
Peter Collingbourne0312f612016-06-25 00:23:04 +000012312'``llvm.type.checked.load``' Intrinsic
12313^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12314
12315Syntax:
12316"""""""
12317
12318::
12319
12320 declare {i8*, i1} @llvm.type.checked.load(i8* %ptr, i32 %offset, metadata %type) argmemonly nounwind readonly
12321
12322
12323Arguments:
12324""""""""""
12325
12326The first argument is a pointer from which to load a function pointer. The
12327second argument is the byte offset from which to load the function pointer. The
12328third argument is a metadata object representing a :doc:`type identifier
12329<TypeMetadata>`.
12330
12331Overview:
12332"""""""""
12333
12334The ``llvm.type.checked.load`` intrinsic safely loads a function pointer from a
12335virtual table pointer using type metadata. This intrinsic is used to implement
12336control flow integrity in conjunction with virtual call optimization. The
12337virtual call optimization pass will optimize away ``llvm.type.checked.load``
12338intrinsics associated with devirtualized calls, thereby removing the type
12339check in cases where it is not needed to enforce the control flow integrity
12340constraint.
12341
12342If the given pointer is associated with a type metadata identifier, this
12343function returns true as the second element of its return value. (Note that
12344the function may also return true if the given pointer is not associated
12345with a type metadata identifier.) If the function's return value's second
12346element is true, the following rules apply to the first element:
12347
12348- If the given pointer is associated with the given type metadata identifier,
12349 it is the function pointer loaded from the given byte offset from the given
12350 pointer.
12351
12352- If the given pointer is not associated with the given type metadata
12353 identifier, it is one of the following (the choice of which is unspecified):
12354
12355 1. The function pointer that would have been loaded from an arbitrarily chosen
12356 (through an unspecified mechanism) pointer associated with the type
12357 metadata.
12358
12359 2. If the function has a non-void return type, a pointer to a function that
12360 returns an unspecified value without causing side effects.
12361
12362If the function's return value's second element is false, the value of the
12363first element is undefined.
12364
12365
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012366'``llvm.donothing``' Intrinsic
12367^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12368
12369Syntax:
12370"""""""
12371
12372::
12373
12374 declare void @llvm.donothing() nounwind readnone
12375
12376Overview:
12377"""""""""
12378
Juergen Ributzkac9161192014-10-23 22:36:13 +000012379The ``llvm.donothing`` intrinsic doesn't perform any operation. It's one of only
Sanjoy Das7a4c94d2016-02-26 03:33:59 +000012380three intrinsics (besides ``llvm.experimental.patchpoint`` and
12381``llvm.experimental.gc.statepoint``) that can be called with an invoke
12382instruction.
Sean Silvab084af42012-12-07 10:36:55 +000012383
12384Arguments:
12385""""""""""
12386
12387None.
12388
12389Semantics:
12390""""""""""
12391
12392This intrinsic does nothing, and it's removed by optimizers and ignored
12393by codegen.
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +000012394
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +000012395'``llvm.experimental.deoptimize``' Intrinsic
12396^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12397
12398Syntax:
12399"""""""
12400
12401::
12402
12403 declare type @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
12404
12405Overview:
12406"""""""""
12407
12408This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
12409<deopt_opbundles>`, allow frontends to express transfer of control and
12410frame-local state from the currently executing (typically more specialized,
12411hence faster) version of a function into another (typically more generic, hence
12412slower) version.
12413
12414In languages with a fully integrated managed runtime like Java and JavaScript
12415this intrinsic can be used to implement "uncommon trap" or "side exit" like
12416functionality. In unmanaged languages like C and C++, this intrinsic can be
12417used to represent the slow paths of specialized functions.
12418
12419
12420Arguments:
12421""""""""""
12422
12423The intrinsic takes an arbitrary number of arguments, whose meaning is
12424decided by the :ref:`lowering strategy<deoptimize_lowering>`.
12425
12426Semantics:
12427""""""""""
12428
12429The ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` intrinsic executes an attached
12430deoptimization continuation (denoted using a :ref:`deoptimization
12431operand bundle <deopt_opbundles>`) and returns the value returned by
12432the deoptimization continuation. Defining the semantic properties of
12433the continuation itself is out of scope of the language reference --
12434as far as LLVM is concerned, the deoptimization continuation can
12435invoke arbitrary side effects, including reading from and writing to
12436the entire heap.
12437
12438Deoptimization continuations expressed using ``"deopt"`` operand bundles always
12439continue execution to the end of the physical frame containing them, so all
12440calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must be in "tail position":
12441
12442 - ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` cannot be invoked.
12443 - The call must immediately precede a :ref:`ret <i_ret>` instruction.
12444 - The ``ret`` instruction must return the value produced by the
12445 ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` call if there is one, or void.
12446
12447Note that the above restrictions imply that the return type for a call to
12448``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` will match the return type of its immediate
12449caller.
12450
12451The inliner composes the ``"deopt"`` continuations of the caller into the
12452``"deopt"`` continuations present in the inlinee, and also updates calls to this
12453intrinsic to return directly from the frame of the function it inlined into.
12454
Sanjoy Dase0aa4142016-05-12 01:17:38 +000012455All declarations of ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` must share the
12456same calling convention.
12457
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +000012458.. _deoptimize_lowering:
12459
12460Lowering:
12461"""""""""
12462
Sanjoy Dasdf9ae702016-03-24 20:23:29 +000012463Calls to ``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered to calls to the
12464symbol ``__llvm_deoptimize`` (it is the frontend's responsibility to
12465ensure that this symbol is defined). The call arguments to
12466``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` are lowered as if they were formal
12467arguments of the specified types, and not as varargs.
12468
Sanjoy Dasb51325d2016-03-11 19:08:34 +000012469
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000012470'``llvm.experimental.guard``' Intrinsic
12471^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12472
12473Syntax:
12474"""""""
12475
12476::
12477
12478 declare void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1, ...) [ "deopt"(...) ]
12479
12480Overview:
12481"""""""""
12482
12483This intrinsic, together with :ref:`deoptimization operand bundles
12484<deopt_opbundles>`, allows frontends to express guards or checks on
12485optimistic assumptions made during compilation. The semantics of
12486``@llvm.experimental.guard`` is defined in terms of
12487``@llvm.experimental.deoptimize`` -- its body is defined to be
12488equivalent to:
12489
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000012490.. code-block:: text
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000012491
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000012492 define void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %pred, <args...>) {
12493 %realPred = and i1 %pred, undef
12494 br i1 %realPred, label %continue, label %leave [, !make.implicit !{}]
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000012495
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000012496 leave:
12497 call void @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"() ]
12498 ret void
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000012499
Renato Golin124f2592016-07-20 12:16:38 +000012500 continue:
12501 ret void
12502 }
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000012503
Sanjoy Das47cf2af2016-04-30 00:55:59 +000012504
12505with the optional ``[, !make.implicit !{}]`` present if and only if it
12506is present on the call site. For more details on ``!make.implicit``,
12507see :doc:`FaultMaps`.
12508
Sanjoy Das021de052016-03-31 00:18:46 +000012509In words, ``@llvm.experimental.guard`` executes the attached
12510``"deopt"`` continuation if (but **not** only if) its first argument
12511is ``false``. Since the optimizer is allowed to replace the ``undef``
12512with an arbitrary value, it can optimize guard to fail "spuriously",
12513i.e. without the original condition being false (hence the "not only
12514if"); and this allows for "check widening" type optimizations.
12515
12516``@llvm.experimental.guard`` cannot be invoked.
12517
12518
Peter Collingbourne7dd8dbf2016-04-22 21:18:02 +000012519'``llvm.load.relative``' Intrinsic
12520^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
12521
12522Syntax:
12523"""""""
12524
12525::
12526
12527 declare i8* @llvm.load.relative.iN(i8* %ptr, iN %offset) argmemonly nounwind readonly
12528
12529Overview:
12530"""""""""
12531
12532This intrinsic loads a 32-bit value from the address ``%ptr + %offset``,
12533adds ``%ptr`` to that value and returns it. The constant folder specifically
12534recognizes the form of this intrinsic and the constant initializers it may
12535load from; if a loaded constant initializer is known to have the form
12536``i32 trunc(x - %ptr)``, the intrinsic call is folded to ``x``.
12537
12538LLVM provides that the calculation of such a constant initializer will
12539not overflow at link time under the medium code model if ``x`` is an
12540``unnamed_addr`` function. However, it does not provide this guarantee for
12541a constant initializer folded into a function body. This intrinsic can be
12542used to avoid the possibility of overflows when loading from such a constant.
12543
Andrew Trick5e029ce2013-12-24 02:57:25 +000012544Stack Map Intrinsics
12545--------------------
12546
12547LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching
12548mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics
12549are described in :doc:`StackMaps`.